Explosives - and - Demolitions - Headquarters FM 5-250
Explosives - and - Demolitions - Headquarters FM 5-250
Explosives - and - Demolitions - Headquarters FM 5-250
July 2007
DISTRIBUTION RESTRICTION: Distribution authorized to U.S. Government agencies only to protect technical or
operational information from automatic dissemination under the International Exchange Program or by other
means. This protection applies to publications required solely for official use and to those containing valuable
technical or operational information. This determination was made on 6 November 2006. Other requests for this
document must be referred to Commandant, United States Army Engineer School, ATTN: ATSE-DD,
320 MANSCEN Loop, Suite 336, Fort Leonard Wood, Missouri 65473-8929 or higher authority.
DESTRUCTION NOTICE: Destroy by any method that will prevent disclosure of contents or reconstruction of the
document.
Change 1 Headquarters
Department of the Army
Washington, DC, 27 August 2008
Official:
JOYCE E. MORROW
Administrative Assistant to the
Secretary of the Army
0822601
DISTRIBUTION:
Active Army, Army National Guard, and U.S. Army Reserve. To be distributed in
accordance with the initial distribution number (IDN) 110022, requirements for
FM 3-34.214.
*FM 3-34.214 (FM 5-250)
Contents
Page
PREFACE................................................................................................................... xv
Chapter 1 MILITARY EXPLOSIVES.......................................................................................... 1-1
Section I – Demolition Materials ............................................................................ 1-1
Explosive Selection ................................................................................................... 1-1
Domestic Explosives ................................................................................................. 1-3
Foreign Explosives .................................................................................................... 1-4
Expedient Demolition Charges.................................................................................. 1-4
Section II – Service Demolition Charges............................................................... 1-4
Block Demolition Charge ........................................................................................... 1-4
Trinitrotoluene Block Demolition Charge................................................................... 1-5
M112 Block Demolition Charge................................................................................. 1-6
M186 Roll Demolition Charge ................................................................................... 1-7
40-Pound, Composition H6 Cratering Charge........................................................... 1-7
M1 Military Dynamite ................................................................................................. 1-8
Shaped Demolition Charge ....................................................................................... 1-9
M1A2 Bangalore Torpedo Demolition Kit ................................................................1-12
M1A3 Bangalore Torpedo Demolition Kit ................................................................1-12
M4 Selectable, Lightweight Attack Munition............................................................1-13
M300 Fighting Position Excavator and M301 Fighting Position Excavator
Reload Kit ................................................................................................................1-17
Section III – Demolition Accessories................................................................... 1-18
M700 Time-Blasting Fuse........................................................................................1-18
DISTRIBUTION RESTRICTION: Distribution authorized to U.S. Government agencies only to protect technical
or operational information from automatic dissemination under the International Exchange Program or by other
means. This protection applies to publications required solely for official use and to those containing valuable
technical or operational information. This determination was made on 6 November 2006. Other requests for this
document must be referred to Commandant, United States Army Engineer School, ATTN: ATSE-DD,
320 MANSCEN Loop, Suite 336, Fort Leonard Wood, Missouri 65473-8929 or higher authority.
DESTRUCTION NOTICE: Destroy by any method that will prevent disclosure of contents or reconstruction of the
document.
11 July 2007 i
Contents
Figures
Figure 1-1. TNT Block Demolition Charges............................................................................ 1-5
Figure 1-2. M112 Block Demolition Charge ........................................................................... 1-6
Figure 1-3. M186 Roll Demolition Charge .............................................................................. 1-7
Figure 1-4. 40-Pound, Composition H6 Cratering Charge ..................................................... 1-8
Figure 1-5. M1 Military Dynamite............................................................................................ 1-8
Figure 1-6. Shaped Demolition Charges ................................................................................ 1-9
Figure 1-7. M1A2 or M1A3 Bangalore Torpedo ...................................................................1-12
Figure 1-8. M4 SLAM ...........................................................................................................1-14
Figure 1-9. Bottom-Attack Mode...........................................................................................1-15
Figure 1-10. Side-Attack Mode.............................................................................................1-16
Figure 1-11. Timed-Demolition Mode...................................................................................1-16
Figure 1-12. Command-Detonation Mode............................................................................1-16
Figure 1-13. M300 FPE Kit ...................................................................................................1-17
Figure 1-14. M700 Time Fuse ..............................................................................................1-19
Figure 1-15. Detonating Cord ...............................................................................................1-19
Figure 1-16. Electric Blasting Caps ......................................................................................1-21
Figure 1-17. Nonelectric Blasting Caps................................................................................1-21
Figure 1-18. Booster.............................................................................................................1-22
Figure 1-19. M1A4 and M1A5 Priming Adapters..................................................................1-23
Figure 1-20. M8 Blasting Cap Holder ...................................................................................1-23
Figure 1-21. M1 Detonating Cord Clip..................................................................................1-24
Figure 1-22. M2 Cap Crimper...............................................................................................1-25
Figure 1-23. M51 Blasting Cap Test Set ..............................................................................1-26
Figure 1-24. M34 Blasting Machine......................................................................................1-27
Figure 1-25. CD450-4J Blasting Machine ............................................................................1-28
Figure 1-26. RL39A Firing Wire Reel ...................................................................................1-30
Figure 1-27. M60 Fuse Igniter ..............................................................................................1-31
Figure 1-28. M81 Fuse Igniter ..............................................................................................1-32
Figure 2-1. Nonelectric Initiating Set ...................................................................................... 2-1
Figure 2-2. Cutting a Time Fuse............................................................................................. 2-2
Figure 2-3. Crimping a Blasting Cap Onto a Fuse ................................................................. 2-4
Figure 2-4. Lighting a Time Fuse With a Match ..................................................................... 2-5
Figure 2-5. Electric Initiating Set............................................................................................. 2-6
Figure 2-6. Western Union Pigtail Splice and Tension Knot .................................................. 2-6
Figure 2-7. Two-Wire Splice ................................................................................................... 2-7
Tables
Table 1-1. Characteristics of U.S. Explosives ........................................................................ 1-2
Table 1-2. Characteristics of Block Demolition Charges........................................................ 1-5
Table 1-3. Characteristics of Boreholes Made By Shaped Charges....................................1-11
Table 1-4. M4 SLAM Characteristics....................................................................................1-14
Table 1-5. Demolition Materials............................................................................................1-33
Table 1-6. U.S. Mines...........................................................................................................1-36
Table 1-7. DODIC Index for Demolition Materials ................................................................1-37
Table 2-1. M11 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-36
Table 2-2. M12 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-38
Table 2-3. M21 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-40
Table 2-4. M13 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-42
Table 2-5. M23 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-44
Table 2-6. M14 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-46
Table 2-7. M18 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-48
Table 2-8. M15 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-50
Table 2-9. M151 Characteristics ..........................................................................................2-52
Table 2-10. M152 Characteristics.........................................................................................2-54
Table 2-11. M19 Characteristics...........................................................................................2-56
Table 2-12. M9 Characteristics.............................................................................................2-58
Table 2-13. M81 Characteristics...........................................................................................2-60
Table 3-1. Breaching Charge Thickness ................................................................................ 3-3
Table 3-2. Timber-Cutting Charge Size.................................................................................. 3-9
Table 3-3. Hasty, Steel-Cutting Chart for TNT .....................................................................3-11
Table 3-4. Hasty, Steel-Cutting Chart for Composition C4 ..................................................3-12
Table 3-5. Material Factor (K) for Breaching Charges .........................................................3-18
Table 3-6. Breaching Charges for Reinforced Concrete ......................................................3-20
Table 3-7. Conversion Factors for Material Other Than Reinforced Concrete ....................3-21
Table 3-8. Single-Line Ditching Explosives Data .................................................................3-29
Table 3-9. Cross-Section Ditching Explosives Data.............................................................3-30
electronic DA Form 2028 or comments and recommendations in the DA Form 2028 format by e-mail to
<[email protected]>.
Unless this publication states otherwise, masculine nouns and pronouns do not refer exclusively to men.
EXPLOSIVE SELECTION
1-1. Explosives selected should fit the particular purpose, based on their relative power. Consider all
characteristics when selecting an explosive for a particular demolition project. For detailed information on
military explosives, see Technical Manual (TM) 9-1300-214. Table 1-1, pages 1-2 and 1-3, contains
significant information regarding many United States (U.S.) explosives. See Appendix B for equivalent
metric weights of standard explosives.
Detonation
Velocity RE Fume Water
Name Applications
Factor* Toxicity Resistance
M/Sec Ft/Sec
Ammonium
Earthmoving 2,700 8,900 0.42 Dangerous Poor
nitrate
Detonating cord
PETN Blasting caps 8,300 27,200 1.66 Slight Excellent
Demolition charges
Blasting caps
RDX Composition 8,350 27,400 1.60 Dangerous Excellent
explosive
Demolition charge
TNT Composition 6,900 22,600 1.00 Dangerous Excellent
explosive
Booster charge
Tetryl Composition 7,100 23,300 1.25 Dangerous Excellent
explosive
Nitroglycerin Commercial dynamite 7,700 25,200 1.50 Dangerous Good
Black powder Time fuse 400 1,300 0.55 Dangerous Poor
Amatol 80/20 Bursting charge 4,900 16,000 1.17 Dangerous Poor
Booster charge
Composition A3 8,100 26,500 — Dangerous Good
Bursting charge
Composition B Bursting charge 7,800 25,600 1.35 Dangerous Excellent
Composition Cutting charge
C4 (M112) 8,040 26,400 1.34 Slight Excellent
Breaching charge
Composition
Cratering charge 7,190 23,600 1.33 Dangerous Excellent
H6
Ammonium
Cratering charge 2,700 8,900 0.42 Dangerous Poor
nitrate
Tetrytol 75/25 Demolition charge 7,000 23,000 1.20 Dangerous Excellent
Booster charge
Pentolite 50/50 7,450 24,400 — Dangerous Excellent
Bursting charge
M1 dynamite Demolition charge 6,100 20,000 0.92 Dangerous Fair
6,100 20,000
Priming
Detonating cord to to 1.66 Slight Excellent
Demolition charge
7,300 24,000
Sheet explosive
Cutting charge 7,300 24,000 1.14 Dangerous Excellent
(M186)
Bangalore
Demolition charge 7,800 25,600 1.17 Dangerous Excellent
torpedo, M1A2
Shaped
charges M2A3,
Cutting charge 7,800 25,600 1.17 Dangerous Excellent
M2A4, and
M3A1
Detonation
Velocity RE Fume Water
Name Applications
Factor* Toxicity Resistance
M/Sec Ft/Sec
Binary mix,
Sodium
perchlorate, FPE main charges 4,000 13,100 1.60 Slight Good
and Aluminum
powder
*TNT equals 1.00 RE.
DOMESTIC EXPLOSIVES
1-2. The paragraphs below discuss the different types of domestic explosives. Domestic explosives
include ammonium nitrate, trinitrotoluene (TNT) , composition C4, and dynamite.
AMMONIUM NITRATE
1-3. Ammonium nitrate is the least sensitive of military explosives. For successful detonation, it requires
a booster charge. Because of its low sensitivity, ammonium nitrate is a component of many composite
explosives (combined with a more sensitive explosive). Ammonium nitrate is not suitable for cutting or
breaching charges because it has a low detonating velocity. Commercial quarrying operations use
ammonium nitrate demolitions extensively. Ammonium nitrate should be packed in an airtight container
because it is extremely hygroscopic (absorbs humidity). Ammonium nitrate or composite explosives
containing ammonium nitrate are not suitable for underwater use unless packed in waterproof containers or
detonated immediately after placement.
TRINITROTOLUENE
1-4. TNT may be in a composite (such as booster, bursting, or demolition charges) or a noncomposite
form. Since TNT is a standard explosive, it is used to rate other military explosives.
COMPOSITION C4
1-5. Composition C4 is a composite explosive containing 91 percent cyclotrimethlenetrinitramine (RDX)
and 9 percent nonexplosive plasticizers. Booster charges are composed of composition C4. Composition C4
is effective in temperatures between 70°F-170°F; however, composition C4 loses its plasticity in colder
temperatures.
DYNAMITE
1-6. The paragraphs below discuss the different dynamite types. Dynamite types include standard,
military, and binary explosives (fighting position excavator [FPE]).
Standard
1-7. Most dynamites, with the notable exception of military dynamite, contain ammonium nitrate plus
varying combinations of absorbents, oxidizers, antacids, and freezing point depressants. Dynamites vary in
strength and sensitivity depending on, among other factors, the percentage of ammonium nitrate. Some
nitroglycerin-based dynamites are still available for general blasting and demolitions, including land
clearing, cratering and ditching, and quarrying.
Military
1-8. Military dynamite is a composite explosive that contains 75 percent cyclotrimethlenetrinitramine
(RDX) (also known as cyclonite), 15 percent TNT, and 10 percent desensitizers and plasticizers. Military
dynamite is not as powerful as commercial dynamite. The equivalent strength of military dynamite is
60 percent of commercial dynamite. Because military dynamite contains no nitroglycerin, it is stabler and
safer to store and handle than commercial dynamite.
FOREIGN EXPLOSIVES
1-10. Foreign countries use a variety of explosives, including TNT, picric acid, amatol, and guncotton.
Picric acid is similar to TNT, but it also corrodes metals, forming extremely sensitive compounds.
WARNING
Do not handle picric acid. Notify explosive ordnance disposal
(EOD) (the detection, identification, on-site evaluation, rendering
safe, recovery, and final disposal of unexploded ordnance. It may
also include explosive ordnance which has become hazardous by
damage or deterioration) (Joint Publication [JP] 1-02) personnel
for disposition. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
1-11. Explosives of allied nations and those captured from the enemy can be used to supplement standard
supplies. Use these explosives according to the instructions and directives of theater commanders. Captured
bombs, propellants, and other devices may be used with U.S. military explosives for larger demolition
projects, such as pier, bridge, tunnel, and airfield destruction. Most foreign explosive blocks have cap wells
large enough to receive U.S. military blasting caps. Since foreign explosives may differ from U.S.
explosives in sensitivity and force, make test shots to determine their adequacy before extensive use or
mixing with U.S.-type explosives. Additional information on the use of demolition charges is in Appendix
C.
which are all cylindrical in form. The various block charges available are described below, as well as in
Table 1-2. See TM 43-0001-38 for detailed information about demolition charges and accessories.
Detonation
Unit RE Packaging and
Explosive Size (in) Velocity 1
(lb) Factor Weight
M/Sec Ft/Sec
0.25 1 1/2 x 3 1/2 6,900 22,600 1.00 192 per box/55 lb
2
TNT 0.50 1 3/4 x 1 3/4 x 3 3/4 6,900 22,600 1.00 96 per box/53 lb
1.00 1 3/4 x 1 3/4 x 7 6,900 22,600 1.00 48 per box/53 lb
M112 block 1.25 1 x 2 x 10 8,040 26,400 1.34 30 per box/40 lb
M186 roll 25.00 1/4 x 3 x 600 7,300 24,000 1.14 3 per box/80 lb
2
Composition H6 43.00 7 x 20 7,190 23,600 1.33 1 per box/52 lb
2
M1 dynamite 0.50 1 1/4 x 8 6,100 20,000 0.92 100 per box/62 lb
1
Packaging weights include the packaging material and the weight of the container.
2
The 1/4-pound block of TNT, the composition H6 cratering charge, and the M1 dynamite are cylindrical in shape and
described in terms of diameter and length.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-15. The TNT charges shown in Figure 1-1 are available in three sizes (Table 1-2). The 1/4-pound block
is issued in a cylindrical, waterproof, olive drab cardboard container. The 1/2-pound and 1-pound blocks
are available in similar rectangular containers. All of the three charges have metal ends with a threaded cap
well in one end.
USES
1-16. TNT charges are effective for all types of demolition work, except for special steel-cutting charges.
However, the 1/4-pound charge is primarily for training purposes.
ADVANTAGES
1-17. TNT charges have a high detonating velocity. They are stable, relatively insensitive to shock or
friction, and are water resistant. They are conveniently sized, shaped, and packaged.
LIMITATIONS
1-18. TNT charges cannot be molded and are difficult to use on irregularly shaped targets. TNT is not
recommended for use in closed spaces because one of the products of explosion is poisonous gases.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-20. An M112 charge consists of 1 1/4 pounds of composition C4 packed in an olive drab film container
with a pressure-sensitive adhesive tape on one surface (Figure 1-2). A peelable paper cover protects the
tape. Table 1-2 lists additional characteristics of the M112 block.
USES
1-21. The M112 charge is used primarily for cutting and breaching. Because of its high cutting effect and
its ability to be cut and shaped, the M112 charge is ideally suited for cutting irregularly shaped targets, such
as steel. The adhesive backing allows the charge to be placed on any relatively flat, clean, dry surface with
a temperature that is above the freezing point. The M112 charge is the primary block demolition charge
presently in use.
WARNING
Composition C4 explosive is poisonous and dangerous if chewed
or ingested; its detonation or burning produces poisonous fumes.
Cut all plastic explosives with a sharp, nonsparking steel knife on
a nonsparking surface. Shears should not be used. Failure to
comply could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
ADVANTAGES
1-22. The M112 block demolition charge can be cut or molded to fit irregularly shaped targets. The color
of the wrapper helps camouflage the charge.
LIMITATIONS
1-23. The adhesive tape will not adhere to wet, dirty, rusty, or frozen surfaces. Molding the charge can
decrease its cutting effect.
M1 MILITARY DYNAMITE
1-26. M1 military dynamite is discussed below. Discussed are the characteristics, uses, advantages, and
limitations of M1 military dynamite.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-27. M1 military dynamite is an RDX-based composite explosive containing no nitroglycerin
(Figure 1-5). M1 dynamite is packaged in 1/2-pound, paraffin-coated, cylindrical paper cartridges, which
have a nominal diameter of 1 1/4 inches and a nominal length of 8 inches. Table 1-2, page 1-4, lists
additional characteristics for M1 military dynamite.
USES
1-28. The primary use of M1 dynamite is for stump removal, military construction, quarrying, ditching,
and service demolition work. M1 is suitable for underwater demolitions.
ADVANTAGES
1-29. M1 dynamite will not freeze or perspire in storage. Its composition is not hygroscopic. Unlike
civilian dynamite containers, military shipping containers do not require turning during storage. M1
dynamite is safer to store, handle, and transport than 60 percent of commercial dynamite. Unless essential,
do not use civilian dynamite in combat areas.
LIMITATIONS
1-30. M1 dynamite is reliable underwater for only 24 hours. Because of its low sensitivity, sticks of
military dynamite should be packed well to ensure complete detonation of the charge. M1 dynamite is not
efficient as a cutting or breaching charge.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-32. Following are the characteristics of the 15-pound M2A4 shaped demolition charge. Also discussed
are the characteristics of the 40-pound M3A1 shaped demolition charge.
USES
1-35. The primary use of a shaped demolition charge is for boring holes in the earth, metal, masonry,
concrete, and paved and unpaved roads. Its effectiveness depends largely on its shape, composition, and
placement. Table 1-3, pages 1-11 and 1-12, lists the penetrating capabilities of various materials and the
proper standoff distances for these charges.
M2A4, M3A1,
Material Specifications Shaped Charge* Shaped Charge**
(15 lb) (40 lb)
M2A4, M3A1,
Material Specifications Shaped Charge* Shaped Charge**
(15 lb) (40 lb)
SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS
1-36. To achieve the maximum effectiveness of shaped charges—
コ Center the charge over the target point.
コ Align the axis of the charge with the direction of the desired hole.
コ Use the pedestal to obtain the proper standoff distance.
コ Suspend the charge at the proper height on pickets or tripods if the pedestal does not provide the
proper standoff distance.
コ Remove any obstruction in the cavity liner or between the charge and the target.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-39. Each kit consists of 10 tube assemblies, connecting sleeves, and two nose sleeves. The tube
assemblies, or torpedoes, are steel tubes 2 1/2 feet long and 2 1/8 inches in diameter, grooved and capped at
each end (Figure 1-7). The torpedoes have a 4-inch composition A3 booster (1/2 pound each) at both ends
of each 2 1/2 foot section. The main explosive charge is 5 pounds of composition B4.
USES
1-40. The primary use of the torpedo is for clearing paths through wire obstacles and heavy undergrowth.
It will clear a 3- to 4-yard-wide path through wire obstacles.
DANGER
The bangalore torpedo may detonate a live mine when being
placed. To aid in preventing this, attach the nose sleeve to a
fabricated dummy section (about the same dimensions as a
single bangalore section), and place the dummy section onto the
front end of the torpedo. Failure to comply may cause death or
permanent injury.
ASSEMBLY
1-41. All sections of the torpedo have threaded cap wells at each end. To assemble two or more sections,
press a nose sleeve onto one end of one tube, and then connect successive tubes (using the connecting
sleeves provided) until you have the desired length. The connecting sleeves make rigid joints. The nose
sleeve allows the user to push the torpedo through entanglements and across the ground.
DANGER
Do not modify the bangalore torpedo. Cutting the bangalore or
making any other modification could cause the device to explode.
Failure to comply may cause death or permanent injury.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-43. The M4 SLAM (Figure 1-8, page 1-14) (Table 1-4, page 1-14) is olive green in color with a black
liner and no labels, bands, or other distinguishing marks. When the M4 SLAM is employed, the operator
selects the operating mode and length of time that it will function to defeat selected targets using an
explosively formed penetrator (EFP) warhead. During bottom- and side-attack modes, the M4 SLAM will
self-destruct if the selected time expires before a vehicle detonates it. With the time demolition mode, the
M4 SLAM will detonate after the selected time delay has expired. Other versions of this munition are the
M2 and M3 special operations forces (SOF) SLAM. The M2 version will self-disarm and will go into dud
status (cannot be rearmed). The M3 version can only be initiated by command detonating the unit. The
packaging protects the M4 SLAM so it will function with no degradation attributable to packaging after up
to 2 years with outside, unprotected, uncontrolled storage, and 20 years protected controlled storage. No
new or unique storage facilities are anticipated for the M4 SLAM munition. Individual M4 SLAMs are
contained in their own reusable environmental protective packs (REPPs) that consist of two-piece plastic
containers consisting of a top and bottom half held together with four clips. There are eight REPPs, eight
carrying straps, and eight leg straps in each PA19 container. The packaged ammunition is palletized on a
wooden pallet. The pallet consists of 2 PA19 containers per wire-bound box and 27 wire-bound boxes for a
total of 54 PA19 containers.
Pallet Dimensions
Length 45 1/2 in
Width 35 13/16 in
Height 43 15/16 in
Weight (loaded) 2,016 lb
M4 SLAM Weights and Dimensions
Weight 2.2 lb
Length 5.15 in
Width 3.5 in
Depth 2.15 in
USES
1-44. The M4 SLAM is a small antidisturbance and tamper resistant, multipurpose munition designed to be
portable, hand emplaced, and used against lightly armored infantry vehicles, parked aircraft, wheeled or
tracked support vehicles, and ammunition or petroleum, oils, and lubricants (POL) storage sites.
DANGER
Never approach the M4 SLAM for any reason. Once armed, the M4
SLAM will detonate. Failure to comply may cause death or
permanent injury.
DANGER
During live-fire training, an initiating system (such as wire,
detonating cord, or shock tube) must be laid out to a safe location
away from the SLAM before arming the SLAM so that the SLAM
can be safely initiated in case of an electronic shutdown or a dud
(an explosive munition which has not been armed as intended or
which has failed to explode after being armed) (JP 1-02). Failure
to comply may cause death or permanent injury.
ADVANTAGES
1-45. The M4 SLAM can be used day or night and during all weather conditions. The four operating
modes include—
コ Bottom-attack mode. See Figure 1-9. The M4 SLAM has a built-in magnetic sensor that allows
it to be used as a magnetic-influenced munition against trucks or lightly armored vehicles. The
magnetic sensor is designed to trigger detonation when it senses a vehicle overpass. It can be
concealed along trails and roads where target vehicles operate and can be camouflaged using
light overburden, dry leaves, and grass without affecting EFP performance as long as debris does
not extend beyond the depth of the EFP cup level. The M4 SLAM self-destructs if the selected
time expires before a passing vehicle detonates the munition.
LIMITATIONS
1-47. The M4 SLAM warhead performance may be affected by heavy overburden. If the M4 SLAM needs
to be hidden from view, a light layer of grass or leaves can be used to cover it. To defeat the target, the EFP
needs a minimum of 5 inches from the point of emplacement to the target to form properly.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-49. Each M300 FPE kit (Figure 1-13) comes in a canvas carrying bag and contains a four-piece bucket
auger, an empty sandbag, two binary explosive containers (each with a booster assembly permanently
installed), a blasting cap assembly with an M9 holder attached, and an M81 fuse igniter. The binary charges
consist of two nonexplosive components that must be mixed together to form an explosive compound. The
booster assemblies that prime the charges consist of a booster (containing only secondary explosive),
crimped to a length of low-strength detonating cord (a waterproof, flexible fabric tube containing a HE
designed to transmit the detonation wave) (JP 1-02) to allow charge emplacement belowground. The
blasting cap assembly consists of a military-type blasting cap crimped to a 25-meter length of shock tube.
The auger is used to dig holes for emplacing the charges and for measuring hole depth and separation. The
M301 FPE reload kit provides additional explosives and sandbags for creating two additional two-man
fighting positions. It is packaged in the same FPE canvas carrying bag. The operator must use the auger
from an FPE kit to dig holes for emplacing the explosive charges of the reload kit.
USES
1-50. The FPE system is used to loosen the soil. The time it takes to dig a two-man fighting position is
reduced by the FPE system.
EMPLACEMENT
1-51. The dimensions of a two-man fighting position (6 feet by 2 feet) are laid out on the ground. A bucket
auger should be used to dig a hole one foot in from the end of the outline. The length of the bucket auger is
used as a measuring device. When the handle of the auger is 1 to 2 inches above the ground hole, the depth
is about 40 inches. The length of the bucket auger is used to measure the distance to a second hole location.
A second hole is dug to the same depth as the first.
1-52. The protective cap is then unscrewed and removed from the end of the liquid tube. The liquid tube
should be unscrewed and separated from the powder tube. The liquid tube should be held in one hand with
the seal facing up to prevent spillage of the liquid component during assembly. The sealed end of the
powder tube should be aligned over the liquid tube, then the two tubes should be screwed together. The
tubes should be securely seated and the explosive container shook vigorously for one minute to ensure
thorough mixing. After unwinding the length of the low-strength detonating cord from the spool on the
powder containers, one container is lowered into each hole while the low-strength detonating cord is held
out of the hole. The charges should be tamped with loose dirt.
1-53. Low-strength detonating cord is connected to the blasting cap assembly using the M9 holder attached
to the blasting cap. The low-strength detonating cord is spread between the primed charge and the M9
holder of the transmission line. Avoid conditions where cords are running alongside or twisted with other
cord to minimize crossover of any low-strength detonating cord.
1-54. The shock tube is run to a sheltered position about 25 meters from the buried charges. A square cut is
made at the end of the shock tube assembly and an M81 fuse igniter is attached. The safety pin is removed
from the M81 and the pull ring is pulled sharply to initiate the explosive train.
DETONATING CORD
1-56. The American, British, Canadian, and Australian (ABCA) standardization program recognizes
Type 1 detonating cord as the standard detonating cord. The paragraphs below discuss the characteristics,
uses, and precautions of detonating cord.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-57. Detonating cord (Figure 1-15) consists of a core of HE (6.4 pounds of pentaerythrite tetranitrate
[PETN] per 1,000 feet) wrapped in a reinforced and waterproof, olive drab plastic coating. This detonating
cord is about 0.2 inch in diameter, weighs about 18 pounds per 1,000 feet, and has a breaking strength of
175 pounds. Detonating cord is functional in the same temperature range as plastic explosive, although the
cover becomes brittle at lower temperatures. Moisture can penetrate the explosive filling to a maximum
distance of 6 inches from any cut or break in the coating. Water-soaked detonating cord will detonate if
there is a dry end to allow initiation. A 6-inch tail should be left when making connections or when priming
charges.
USES
1-58. Detonating cord can be used to prime and detonate single or multiple explosive charges
simultaneously. Chapter 2 explains the use of detonating cord for these purposes.
PRECAUTIONS
1-59. The end of the detonating cord is sealed with a waterproof sealant when used to fire (1. The
command given to discharge a weapon(s). 2. To detonate the main explosive charge by means of a firing
system) (JP 1-02) (FM 1-02) underwater charges or when charges are left in place several hours before
firing. If left for no longer than 24 hours, a 6-inch overlap will protect the remainder of the line from
moisture. Kinks, sharp bends in priming, or unintended crossovers should be avoided because they may
interrupt or change the direction of detonation and cause misfires.
BLASTING CAPS
1-60. Blasting caps are for detonating HEs. The two types of blasting caps are electric and nonelectric.
They are designed for insertion into the cap wells and are the detonating element in certain firing systems
and devices. Blasting caps are rated in power according to the size of their main charge. Number 6 and 8
commercial blasting caps are for detonating sensitive explosives, such as commercial dynamite and tetryl.
Special military blasting caps (M6 electric and M7 nonelectric) ensure positive detonation of less sensitive
military explosives. Their main charge is about double that of commercial Number 8 blasting caps. Never
carry blasting caps loose or in uniform pockets where they are subject to shock. Properly separate the
blasting caps. Blasting caps should never be stored with other explosives. Blasting caps and other
explosives should not be carried in the same vehicle except in an emergency (see Chapter 6). See TM 43
0001-38 for additional information on blasting caps.
WARNING
Handle military and commercial blasting caps carefully; both are
extremely sensitive and may explode if handled improperly. Do
not tamper with blasting caps. Protect them from shock and
extreme heat. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
ELECTRIC
1-61. Electric blasting caps are used for command detonation or when a source of electricity (such as a
blasting machine or a battery) is available. Both military and commercial caps may be used. Military caps
(Figure 1-16) operate instantaneously. Commercial caps may operate instantaneously or have a delay
feature. The delay time of commercial caps for military applications ranges from 1 to 1.53 seconds. Electric
caps have lead wires of various lengths. The most common lead length is 12 feet. Electric caps require
1.5 amperes of power to initiate. The standard-issue cap is the M6 special electric blasting cap.
NONELECTRIC
1-62. Nonelectric blasting caps are initiated with a time-blasting fuse, a firing device, or detonating cords
(Figure 1-17). Use of nonelectric blasting caps to prime underwater charges should be avoided because the
caps are hard to waterproof. If necessary, waterproof nonelectric blasting caps with a sealing compound.
The M7 nonelectric blasting cap is the standard issue. The open end of the M7 nonelectric blasting cap is
flared to allow easy insertion of detonating cord or a time fuse. TM 43-0001-38 gives additional
information on blasting caps.
BOOSTERS
1-63. A booster is similar in appearance to a blasting cap but contains no primary explosive. The secondary
explosive in the booster contains enough energy to initiate military explosives. Boosters are precrimped to
low-strength detonating cord on the M151- and the M152-MDI components (Figure 1-18, page 1-22). The
boosters provide a means to prime buried charges by following priming methods for standard military
explosives.
BRANCHLINES
1-70. Detonating cord branchlines are connected by passing them through the trough of the M1 clip and
through the hole in the tongue of the clip. Next, the ring or line main should be placed into the tongue of
the clip so that it crosses over the branchline at a 90° angle, and the crossover is held secure by the tongue.
It may be necessary to bend or form the tongue while doing this (Figure 1-21, Diagram 2).
SPLICES
1-71. The ends of the detonating cords are spliced by first overlapping them about 12 inches. Each loose
end is secured to the other cord by using a clip. The tongues of the clips are bent firmly over both strands.
The connection is made stronger by bending the trough end of the clip back over the tongue (Figure 1-21,
Diagram 3).
M1 ADHESIVE PASTE
1-72. M1 adhesive paste is a sticky, putty-like substance that is used to attach charges to flat, overhead, or
vertical surfaces. Adhesive paste is useful for holding charges while tying them in place or, under some
conditions, for holding the explosive to a target without ties. This paste does not adhere satisfactorily to
dirty, dusty, wet, or oily surfaces. M1 adhesive paste becomes useless when softened by water.
M2 CAP CRIMPER
1-75. An M2 cap crimper (Figure 1-22) is used for squeezing the shell of a nonelectric blasting cap around
a time-blasting fuse, standard coupling base, or detonating cord. Crimp the shell securely to keep the fuse,
base, or cord from being pulled off but not so tightly that it interferes with the operation of the initiating
device. A stop on the handle helps to limit the amount of crimp applied. The M2 crimper forms a water-
resistant groove completely around the blasting cap. A sealing compound is applied to the crimped end of
the blasting cap to waterproof it. The cutting jaw, located on the leg, is shaped and sharpened for cutting
fuses and detonating cords. One leg of the handle is pointed for punching cap wells in explosive materials.
The other leg has a screwdriver end. Cap crimpers are made of a soft, nonsparking metal that conducts
electricity. Do not use cap crimpers as pliers because such use damages the crimping surface. The crimp
hole should be round (not elongated), and the cutting jaws should not be jagged. The cutting jaws should be
kept clean, and they should be used only for cutting fuses and detonating cords.
CHARACTERISTICS
1-77. The M51 is a self-contained unit with a magneto-type impulse generator, an indicator lamp, a handle
to activate the generator, and two binding posts for attaching firing leads. The test set is waterproof and
capable of operating at temperatures as low as 40°F (Figure 1-23, page 1-26).
USES
1-78. The continuity of the firing wire, blasting cap, and firing circuit (in land operations, an electrical
circuit and/or pyrotechnic loop designed to detonate connected charges from a firing point [the definition
was shortened, and the complete definition is printed in the glossary]) (JP 1-02) should be checked by
connecting the leads to the test set binding posts and then by depressing the handle sharply. If there is a
continuous (intact) circuit, even one created by a short circuit, the indicator lamp will flash. When the
circuit is open, the indicator lamp will not flash.
MAINTENANCE
1-79. The test set should be handled carefully and kept dry to ensure optimum use. Before using, ensure
that the test set is operating properly by using the following steps:
コ Step 1. Hold a piece of bare wire or the legs of the M2 crimpers across the binding posts.
コ Step 2. Depress the handle sharply while watching the indicator lamp (lamp should flash).
コ Step 3. Remove the bare wire or crimper legs from the binding posts.
コ Step 4. Depress the handle sharply while watching the indicator lamp (lamp should not flash).
Both tests should be performed to ensure that the test set is operating properly.
BLASTING MACHINES
1-80. Blasting machines provide the electric impulse needed to initiate electric blasting cap operations.
When operated, the M32, M34, and CD450-4J models use an alternator and a capacitor to energize the
circuit.
コ Step 2. Activate the machine by depressing the handle rapidly three or four times until the neon
indicator lamp flashes.
Note. The lamp is located between the wire terminal posts and cannot be seen until it flashes,
since it is covered by green plastic.
コ Step 3. Insert the firing wire leads into the terminals by pushing down on each terminal post and
inserting the leads into the metal jaws.
コ Step 4. Hold the machine upright (terminals up) in either hand so that the plunger end of the
handle rests in the base of the palm and the fingers grasp the body of the machine. Make sure to
hold the machine correctly since the handles are easily broken.
コ Step 5. Squeeze the handle sharply several times until the charge fires (normally, no more than
three or four squeezes are required).
Operational Test
1-83. An operational test should be conducted on the CD450-4J (Figure 1-25, page 1-28). This test should
be conducted as follows:
コ Step 1. Depress the charge switch and hold it down. The READY-TO-FIRE indicator should
light after 1 to 5 seconds and remain lit as long as the charge switch is held down.
コ Step 2. Continue holding the charge switch down until the READY-TO-FIRE indicator lights,
then wait at least 2 seconds and then depress the FIRE switch. Continue holding both switches
down for 3 seconds. Verify that the—
ト READY-TO-FIRE indicator remains lit for about 1/4 second after the FIRE switch is
depressed.
ト READY-TO-FIRE indicator is unlit after performing the step above.
コ Release both switches after observing the steps above. The blasting machine should be secured.
Note. In temperatures below 32°F, keep the CD450-4J warm until it is ready to use. During cold
temperatures, fresh batteries should be used with each use. The CD450-4J is not waterproof and
when wet will fail to operate.
CAUTION
Keep the lead lines shunted during wiring of the electric detonators.
Personal injury or damage to equipment may result from long-term
failure to follow correct procedures.
コ Step 5. Check the electric detonator circuit continuity and resistance (including the lead lines)
using an approved ohmmeter.
コ Step 6. Shunt the lead lines after checking the circuits until the blast is ready to be initiated.
コ Step 7. Remove the shunted lead lines connection, and connect the wires to the terminals on the
blasting machine.
DANGER
Keep your hands and body clear of the conductors. Contact with
electrical conductors could cause serious injury or death. Failure
to comply may cause death or permanent injury.
コ Step 8. Depress the CHARGE switch and hold it down. The READY-TO-FIRE indicator lights
up when the capacitor reaches 450 volts. Releasing the CHARGE switch will discharge the
capacitor within 3 seconds.
コ Step 9. Continue holding the CHARGE switch down until the READY-TO-FIRE indicator
lights up. Wait at least 2 seconds, and then firmly depress the FIRE switch. Continue holding
both switches down until the firing operation is complete.
Note. If the blasting machine should fail to fire, release both switches, disconnect and shunt the
lead lines, and notify personnel of the blast delay.
コ Step 10. Wait 3 seconds after the firing operation is complete, and then release both switches.
コ Step 11. Disconnect and shunt the lead lines.
コ Step 12. Secure the blasting machine.
FIRING WIRE
1-86. Wire for firing electric charges is available in 200- and 500-foot coils. The two-conductor American
wire gauge (AWG) number 18 is a plastic- or rubber-covered wire available in 500-foot rolls. This wire is
wound on an RL39A reel unit. The single-conductor, AWG number 20 annunciator wire is available in
200-foot coils and is used to make connections between blasting caps and firing wire. The WD1/telegraphic
transfer (TT) communication wire will also work, but it requires a greater power source if more than 500
feet is used. Blasting machines will not initiate the full-rated number of caps connected with more than 500
feet of WD1/TT wire. As a rule of thumb, 10 less caps than the rating of the machine should be used for
each additional 1,000 feet of WD1/TT wire employed.
WARNING
Never attach an M60 igniter to the M151, M152, or detonating
cord. Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury
or damage to equipment.
Note. The M60 fuse igniter will neither physically secure the shock tube nor reliably initiate it.
WARNING
Never attach an M81 igniter to the M151, M152, or detonating
cord. Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury
or damage to equipment.
PURPOSE
1-91. Tables 1-5 through 1-7, pages 1-33 through 1-41, provide a quick reference for demolition materials
common to combat engineering. This is not a comprehensive list and is subject to change.
MATERIALS
1-92. Table 1-5 and Table 1-6, page 1-36, list materials by type, item, status, national stock number (NSN),
and Department of Defense identification code (DODIC). To avoid problems when requesting materials,
use current supply publications.
1-93. Table 1-7, pages 1-37 through 1-41, is used to cross-reference demolition materials by DODIC.
Materials are listed by DODIC in ascending order and by nomenclature.
M609 Destroyer, crypto equip, M2A1, TH4 M757 Assembly, chg, composition C4, M183
M610 Destroyer, file, incendiary, ABC-M4 M767 Igniter, fuse, timed, practice, XM77
Chg, shaped, practice, inert, MK37-1,
M611 Destroyer, file, incendiary, ABC-M4 M784
7 lb
Assembly, composition C2 or C3,
M612 Destroyer, incendiary, TH3 M790
MK127-0, 20 lb
M615 Igniter, document destroyer, M25 M791 Assembly, tetrytol, MK133-0, 20 lb
Assembly, block, composition C4,
M616 Device, firing, M1, 6- to 14-min delay M792
MK138-0, 20 lb
M617 Set, device, firing, M1 M810 Primer, percussion, improved, No. 3
M619 Device, firing, M1, 12- to 32-min delay M814 Destroyer, document, 55 gal, M4
M620 Device, firing, M1, 45- to 115-min delay M820 Kit, explosive, earth rod, No. 1
M622 Device, firing, M1, 210- to 570-min delay M821 Kit, explosive, foxhole digger
Device, firing, M1, 610- to 1,130-min Chg, shaped, composition H6, MK741,
M623 M832
delay 1.5 lb
Chg, shaped, practice, inert, MK74-0,
M624 Device, firing, brass M833
1.3 lb
M625 Device, firing, zinc M836 Cap, electric, dry, instantaneous
M626 Device, firing, zinc M855 Cap, electric, dry, 0.5-sec delay
M910 Igniter, primer and base, XM110 ML10 Chg, shaped, flex, lin, 30 gr/ft
CAUTION
See the safety procedures in Chapter 6 before undertaking any
demolition mission. Personal injury or damage to equipment may result
from long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
COMPONENTS ASSEMBLY
2-2. The initiating set consists of a fuse igniter (that produces the flame that lights the time-blasting fuse), a
time-blasting fuse (that transmits the flame that fires the blasting cap), and a nonelectric blasting cap (that
provides adequate shock to detonate the explosive) (Figure 2-1). For MDI components and the preparation
sequence, see Section IV of this chapter. When combined with detonating cord, a single-initiating set can
fire multiple charges.
PREPARATION SEQUENCE
2-3. Preparing demolitions for nonelectric initiation follows specified processes. These processes are
discussed below.
DANGER
Test-burn a 3-foot length of time-blasting fuse to determine the
exact burn rate before use. Failure to comply may cause death or
permanent injury.
CAUTION
If the charge in the cap is not in contact with the fuse, the fuse may not
ignite the cap (misfire). Never force a time fuse into a blasting cap (for
example, by twisting). If the fuse end is flat or too large to enter the
blasting cap freely, roll the fuse between your thumb and fingers until it
will freely enter the cap. A rough, jagged-cut fuse inserted in a blasting
cap can cause a misfire. If the cutting jaws of the M2 crimper are
unserviceable, use a sharp, nonsparking knife to cut the fuse. When
using a knife to cut the fuse squarely, cut the fuse against a solid,
nonsparking surface such as wood. Personal injury or damage to
equipment may result from long-term failure to follow correct
procedures.
ト Grasp the fuse with your thumb and ring finger while applying slight pressure with your
forefinger on the closed end of the cap.
ト Use the opposite hand to grasp the crimpers. Place the crimping jaws around the cap at a
point 1/8 to 1/4 inch from the open end. Ensure that your thumb and ring finger that hold
the fuse is below the crimpers. Rest the second finger of your hand holding the fuse on top
of the crimpers to prevent the crimpers from sliding up the cap (Figure 2-3, page 2-4).
ト Extend both arms straight out while rotating the hands so that the closed end of the blasting
cap is pointing away from your body and away from other personnel.
ト Tilt your head downward and crimp the blasting cap by firmly squeezing the M2 crimper
handles together. Inspect the crimp when finished.
Note. Attach the M60 or M81 fuse igniter to the time fuse before crimping a blasting cap to the
opposite end. Do not remove the safety pin until the charge is ready to be detonated.
WARNING
To avoid cap detonation, crimp blasting caps 1/8 to 1/4 inch from
the open end of the cap. Failure to comply could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
Note. Protect the joint between the cap and the time-blasting fuse with a coat of sealing
compound or a similar substance if the blasting cap is to remain in place several days before
firing. This sealing compound does not make a waterproof seal; therefore, fire submerged
charges immediately. See Chapter 6, Section II, for procedures on handling nonelectric misfires.
FUSE INITIATION
2-10. To fire the assembly, hold the M60 or M81 igniter in one hand and then remove the safety pin with
the other. While grasping the pull ring, give it a quick, hard pull. In the event of a misfire, reset the M60 or
M81 by pushing the plunger all the way in (for the M60 only, rotate it left or right 180°), and attempt to fire
as before.
CAUTION
Never initiate a fuse igniter underwater. Personal injury or damage to
equipment may result from long-term failure to follow the correct
procedures.
2-11. If a fuse igniter is not available, light the time-blasting fuse with a match. The fuse is split at the end
(Figure 2-4) and the head of an unlit match is placed in the powder train. The inserted match head is lighted
with a flaming match or rubbed against the abrasive on the matchbox. It may be necessary to use two match
heads during windy conditions.
COMPONENTS ASSEMBLY
2-12. An electric system uses an electric blasting cap as the explosion initiator. The initiating set consists
of an electric blasting cap, the firing wire, and a blasting machine (Figure 2-5, page 2-6). An electric
impulse (usually provided by a blasting machine) travels through the firing wire and blasting cap leads,
detonating the blasting cap, which initiates the explosion. Radio waves can also detonate electric blasting
caps. Therefore, observe the minimum safe distances listed in the tables in Chapter 6 at all times. A single-
initiating set can be used to initiate the detonating cord or multiple charges. TM 9-1375-213-34&P provides
detailed information about electric blasting equipment.
CIRCUIT INITIATION
2-13. At this point, the initiating set is complete. The blasting machine should not be connected until all
personnel are accounted for and clearance is received to fire the demolition. When all personnel are clear,
“fire in the hole” is called three times, then the blasting machine is installed and demolition is initiated.
Chapter 6 covers the procedures for electric misfires.
Preparation
2-15. Before splicing, strip the insulating material from the end of the insulated wires. About 1 1/2 inches
of insulation should be removed from the end of each wire (Figure 2-6, step 1). Any coating on the wire
should be removed (such as enamel) by carefully scraping the wire with the back of a knife blade or other
suitable tool. The bare wire should not be nicked, cut, or weakened. After scraping, lightly twist multiple-
strand wires.
Method
2-16. Use the Western union pigtail splice (Figure 2-6) to splice two wires. The two pairs of wires are
spliced in the same way as the 2-wire splice (Figure 2-7). When splicing, use the following steps:
コ Step 1. Protect the splices from tension damage by tying the ends in an overhand or square knot
(tension knot), allowing enough length for each splice (Figure 2-6, step 2).
コ Step 2. Make three twists with each wire (Figure 2-6, step 3).
コ Step 3. Twist the ends together with an additional three turns (Figure 2-6, step 4).
コ Step 4. Flatten the splice, but not so far that the wire crimps itself and breaks (Figure 2-6,
step 5).
Precautions
2-17. A short circuit may occur at a splice if caution is not used. For example, when splicing pairs of wires,
stagger the splices and place a tie between them (Figure 2-7, Diagram 1). Another method of preventing a
short circuit in a splice is using the alternate method (Figure 2-7, Diagram 2). In the alternate method, the
splices are separated rather than stagger them. Splices are insulated from the ground or other conductors by
wrapping them with friction tape or electric insulating tape.
SERIES CIRCUITS
2-18. The two types of series circuits include the common series circuit and the leapfrog series circuit
(Figure 2-8, page 2-8). A common series circuit is used to connect two or more electric blasting caps to a
single-firing wire. The leapfrog series method of connecting caps in a series is useful for firing any long
line of charges.
Note. The indicator lamp should not flash. If it does, the flash of the lamp indicates a short
circuit in the firing wire.
ト Shunt the wires at one end, and connect the leads from the other end to the posts of the M51
test set. Squeeze the test set handle.
Note. The indicator lamp should flash. If it does not, the failure of the lamp to light indicates a
break in the firing wire. At least three 180° twists should be used to shunt the wires.
Note. Hand signals are necessary because of the distance involved between the charges and the
firing position. The Soldier testing the wire can give these signals directly to the Soldier at the
opposite end of the wire or, if they cannot see each other, through intermediate positions or over
the radio. The tester indicates to the assistant that he wants the far end of the firing wire
unshunted by extending both arms straight out at shoulder height. After unshunting the firing
wire, the assistant at the far end of the wire repeats the signal, indicating to the tester that his end
is unshunted. When the tester wants the far end of the firing wire shunted, he signals to the
assistant by clasping his hands together and extending his arms over his head, elbows bent,
forming a diamond shape. After shunting the firing wire, the assistant repeats the signal,
indicating to the tester that the wire is shunted.
ト Shunt both ends of the firing wire after completing the tests.
コ Step 6. Test the electric blasting caps.
ト Remove the cap from its spool. Place the cap in the palm of your hand with the lead wires
passing between your index and middle fingers.
ト Wrap the wire around the palm of your hand twice to prevent tension on the wires in the
cap and the cap from being dropped.
ト Grasp the wire spool with your free hand, and unreel the wire letting the wire pass between
your fingers while turning the spool. Unreel the cap wires completely from the cardboard
spool. Avoid allowing the wires to slip off the ends of the cardboard spool, since this will
cause excessive twists and kinks in the wires and prevent the wires from separating
properly.
ト Place the blasting cap under a sandbag or helmet while extending the wires to their full
length.
ト Test the blasting caps away from all other personnel. Keep your back to the blasting cap
when testing it.
ト Remove the short-circuit shunt from the lead wires.
ト Hold or attach one lead wire to one of the binding posts of the M51. Hold or attach the
second lead wire to the other binding post.
ト Squeeze the test set handle.
Note. The blasting cap is good if the indicator lamp flashes. If the lamp does not flash, the cap is
defective; do not use it.
ト Ensure that the cap wires are kept shunted when not testing them.
コ Step 7. Connect the series circuit (if used) using one of the series circuits shown in Figure 2-8,
page 2-8. Use the following procedures:
ト Test all blasting caps (step 6) separately, before connecting them in a circuit.
ト Join blasting-cap wires together using the Western union pigtail splice and tension knot
(Figure 2-6, page 2-6). Protect all joints in the circuit with electrical insulation tape. Do not
use the cardboard spool that comes with the blasting cap to insulate these connections.
ト Test the entire electrical cap circuit. Connect the two free blasting cap wires to the M51 test
set after the series is completed.
Note. The indicator lamp should flash to indicate a good circuit. If the lamp does not flash, check
the connections and blasting caps again.
ト Test the cap circuit, and then shunt the two free blasting cap wires until you are ready to
connect them to the firing wire.
コ Step 8. Connect the firing wire to the cap wire.
ト Connect the free leads of the blasting caps to the firing wire before priming the charges or
taping a blasting cap to a detonating cord ring main.
ト Use a Western union pigtail splice to connect the firing wire to the blasting cap wires.
ト Insulate the connections with tape. Never use the cardboard spool that comes with the
blasting cap to insulate this connection.
Note. The firing wire is likely to break when bent to fit into the spool.
コ Step 9. Test the entire firing circuit. Test the circuit from the firing point before priming the
charges with electric caps or connecting the blasting caps to the firing circuit. Use the following
procedures:
ト Ensure that the blasting caps are under protective sandbags while performing this test.
ト Connect the ends of the firing wire to the M51 test set.
ト Squeeze the test handle. The indicator lamp should flash, indicating a proper circuit.
ト Shunt the ends of the firing wire.
WARNING
Do not prime the charges with electric blasting caps or connect
electric blasting caps to the detonating cord until all other steps
of the preparation sequence are complete. Failure to comply
could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
コ Step 10. Prime the charges. Prime the charges and return to the firing point. Perform this as the
last step before returning to the firing point and firing the circuit.
WARNING
Prime the charges with the minimum number of personnel on-
site. Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury
or damage to equipment.
PRIMING CHARGES
2-22. The four methods of priming charges are MDI, nonelectric, electric, and detonating cord. MDI,
nonelectric, and electric priming involves directly inserting blasting caps into the charges and MDI M151
and MDI M152 boosters into the charges. MDI M151, MDI M152, or detonating cord priming are the
preferred methods for priming all charges since it involves fewer blasting caps, makes priming and misfire
investigation safer, and allows charges to be primed at state of readiness—state 1 (safe) when in place on a
reserved demolition target (a target of known military interest identified for possible future demolition)
(JP 1-02) or mission.
コ Step 2. Pass the lead wires through the slot of the adapter, and pull the cap into place in the
adapter (Figure 2-12). Ensure that the blasting cap protrudes from the threaded end of the
adapter.
コ Step 3. Insert the blasting cap into the threaded cap well of the TNT block, and screw the
adapter into place.
DETONATING CORD
2-28. The following methods are used to prime TNT blocks with detonating cord (Figure 2-14, page 2-14):
コ Common method. Lay one end (1-foot length) of detonating cord at an angle across the
explosive. Wrap the running end around the block three turns, laying the wraps over the standing
end. On the fourth wrap, slip the running end under all wraps, parallel to the standing end, and
draw the wraps tight. Ensure that this forms a clove hitch with two extra turns.
コ Alternate method. Place a loop of detonating cord on the explosive, leaving enough length on
the end to make four turns around the block, and loop with the remaining end of the detonating
cord. Start the first wrap, and ensure that you immediately cross over the standing end of the
loop. Work your way to the closed end of the loop. Pass the free end of the detonating cord
through the loop, and pull it tight to form a knot around the outside of the block.
DETONATING CORD
2-31. To prime plastic explosives with detonating cord, use the following steps:
コ Step 1. Form either an Uli knot, a double overhand knot, or a triple-roll knot as shown in
Figure 2-15.
コ Step 2. Cut an L-shaped portion of explosive, leaving it connected to the explosive. Ensure that
the space is large enough to insert the formed knot (Figure 2-16).
CAUTION
Use a sharp, nonsparking knife on a nonsparking surface to cut
explosives. Personal injury or damage to equipment may result from
long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
Note. It is not recommended that plastic explosives be primed by wrapping them with detonating
cord, since wraps will not properly detonate the explosive charge.
Note. The M8 blasting cap holder has three slanted, protruding teeth, which prevent the clip
from withdrawing from the explosive. Two dimpled spring arms firmly hold the blasting cap in
the M8 holder.
コ Method 2. Cut a notch in the sheet explosive (about 1 1/2 inches long and 1/4 inch wide). Insert
the blasting cap to the limit of the notch. Secure the blasting cap with a strip of sheet explosive.
コ Method 3. Place 1 1/2 inches of the blasting cap on top of the sheet explosive, and secure it with
a strip of sheet explosive (at least 3 inches by 3 inches).
Note. When using sheet explosives to cut steel, Method 3 is the preferred method.
コ Method 4. Insert 1 1/2 inches of the blasting cap between two sheets of explosive.
DETONATING CORD
2-34. Sheet explosives can be primed with detonating cord using an Uli knot, double overhand knot, or
triple-roll knot. Insert the knot between two sheets of explosive, or place the knot on top of the sheet
explosive and secure it with a small strip of sheet explosive. The knot must be covered on all sides with at
least 1/2 inch of explosive.
PRIMING DYNAMITE
2-35. Dynamite can be primed at either end or side using either the nonelectric, electric, or detonating cord
priming method. These methods are discussed in the paragraphs below.
コ Step 2. Dual-prime a single cratering charge by placing the primed composition C4 packages
parallel to the cratering charge and on opposite sides of it and flush with the top. Firmly hold
them in place with duct tape. Instructions and markings on the canister indicate the exact
placement of the composition C4 (Figure 2-21, Diagram 2, page 2-20).
コ Step 3. Dual-prime two cratering charges by priming them in the same borehole. This requires
one primed composition C4 block on each of the cratering charges, parallel to the charges and
flush with the top. When placed in the borehole, the composition C4 blocks are placed on
opposite sides of the 40-pound charges (Figure 2-21, Diagram 4).
コ Step 4. Ensure that the detonation-cord branchlines (from the composition C4 block) are long
enough to reach the detonating-cord ring mains after the cratering charge is in the ground. To aid
in clearing possible misfires, place tape on the detonating cord from the cratering charge, 1 foot
up.
2-38. The composition H6 cratering charge replaced the 40-pound ammonium-nitrate cratering charge. If
an ammonium-nitrate cratering charge is drawn from an ammonium supply point (ASP), use the following
steps to prime it:
コ Step 1. Dual-prime a single cratering charge by placing the detonating cord into the detonating
cord tunnel. Tie an overhand knot with a 6-inch tail at either lower end of the length of the
detonating cord. Use a minimum of 1 pound of explosive when dual-priming a single cratering
charge. Prime the explosives with detonating cord and tape the charge to the center of the
cratering charge (Figure 2-21, Diagram 1).
コ Step 2. Dual-prime two cratering charges by priming only the detonating cord tunnels of each
charge when placing two charges in the same borehole. The borehole is dual-primed and extra
explosives as shown in Figure 2-21, Diagram 3.
Note. The borehole is dual-primed and extra explosives are not required.
WARNING
Do not prime cratering charges with blasting caps when buried.
Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury or
damage to equipment.
CAUTION
Ammonium nitrate is hygroscopic and ineffective when wet. Therefore,
inspect the metal container for damage or rust. Do not use damaged or
rusty charges. Personal injury or damage to equipment may result from
long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
Note. Use the crimp, tie, prime (CTP) method for shaped charges.
WARNING
Do not dual-prime shaped charges. Prime them only with a
blasting cap in the threaded cap well. Failure to comply could
result in immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
DETONATING CORD
2-45. The torpedo is single-primed by wrapping the detonating cord eight times around the end of the
section, just below the bevel (Figure 2-24). After pulling the knot tight, insert the short end of the
detonating cord into the cap well, and secure it with tape, if needed. Never use the short end (tail) of the
detonating cord to initiate the torpedo. Initiation must come from the running end of the detonating cord.
DUAL PRIMING
2-46. When dual priming the torpedo, use eight wraps with one branchline as before. Then, prime it with a
blasting cap or booster into the cap well.
CAUTION
Exactly eight wraps should be used to prime the bangalore torpedo.
Too many wraps will extend the detonating cord past the booster
charge housing, possibly causing the bangalore torpedo to be cut
without detonating. Too few wraps may cause the bangalore torpedo
to crease without detonating. Personal injury or damage to equipment
may result from long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
WARNING
Never attach an M60 or M81 igniter to the M151, M152, or
detonating cord. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
SINGLE-PRIMED SYSTEM
2-48. Figure 2-25 shows a single-primed system. Each charge is single-primed with a branchline. The
branchline is tied to the line main or ring main. Tying to the ring main is preferred, but construction of a
ring main may not be possible because of the amount of detonating cord. The ring main decreases the
chances of a misfire if a break or cut occurs anywhere within the ring main. The electric, nonelectric, or
combination initiating sets are taped onto the firing system. When using a combination initiating set, the
electric initiation system is always the primary means of initiation. When using dual, nonelectric initiating
sets, the shorter time fuse is the primary initiating set.
DUAL-PRIMED SYSTEM
2-49. Figure 2-26 shows a dual-primed system. Each charge is dual-primed with two branchlines
(Figure 2-27, page 2-26). One branchline is tied to one firing system, and the other branchline is tied to an
independent firing system. Line mains or ring mains may be used; however, they should not be mixed.
Detonating cord will be used as crossovers. Crossovers are used to tie both firing systems together at the
ends. The initiating sets are taped in with the primary initiating set going to one firing system and the
secondary going to the other.
BRANCHLINE
2-53. A branchline is a length of detonating cord between the charge and the firing system. Branchlines
should be attached to a detonating cord ring or line main to fire multiple charges. Combining the branchline
with an initiating set allows a single branchline to be fired. A branchline should be fastened to a main line
with a detonating cord clip (Figure 1-16, page 1-21) or a girth hitch with an extra turn or a Gregory knot
(also known as a cherry knot) (Figure 2-31, page 2-28). The connections of branchlines and line or ring
mains should intersect at right angles. If these connections are not at right angles, the branchline may be
blown off the line main without complete detonation. To prevent moisture contamination and to ensure
positive detonation, leave at least 6 inches of the running end of the branchline beyond the tie. It does not
matter which side of the knot the 6-inch tail is on at the connection of the line or ring main.
Note. Nonelectric blasting caps can be crimped to detonating cord as well as time fuses. This
capability permits simultaneous firing of multiple charges primed with blasting caps.
LINE MAIN
2-54. A line main can fire a single charge or multiple charges (Figure 2-32), but if a break in the line
occurs, the detonating wave will stop at the break. When the risk of having a line main cut is unacceptable,
use a ring main. Line mains are used only when speed is essential. Any number of branchlines can be
connected to a line main. However, you connect only one branchline at any one point unless using a British
junction (Figure 2-33).
RING MAIN
2-55. Ring mains are preferred over line mains because the detonating wave approaches the branchlines
from two directions. The charges will detonate even when there is a break in the ring main. A ring main
will detonate an unlimited number of charges. Branchline connections to the ring main should be at right
angles. Kinks in the lines should not be sharp. Any number of branchlines can be connected to the ring
main; however, never connect a branchline (at the point) where the ring main is spliced. When making
branchline connections, avoid crossing lines. If a line crossing is necessary, provide at least 1 foot of
clearance between the detonating cords. Otherwise, the cords may cut each other and may destroy the firing
system. The methods below describe how to make a ring main (Figure 2-34).
コ Method 1. Make a ring main by bringing the detonating cord back in the form of a loop and
attach it to itself with a girth hitch with an extra turn.
コ Method 2. Make a ring main by making a U shape with the detonating cord, and then attach a
detonating cord crossover at the open end of the U. Use girth hitches with extra turns when
attach the crossover.
SINGLE-PRIMED SYSTEM
2-57. A single line or ring main should be dual-initiated as shown in Figure 2-35. The blasting cap that will
detonate first should be placed closest to the end of the detonating cord (for example, the electric cap of a
combination of initiating sets). Doing this ensures the integrity of the backup system if the first cap
detonates and fails to initiate the line main.
DUAL-PRIMED SYSTEM
2-58. A dual-primed system is initiated as shown in Figure 2-26, page 2-25. However, the blasting caps are
still connected as shown in Figure 2-29, page 2-27.
DANGER
When using a time or safety fuse, uncoil it and lay it out in a
straight line. The time fuse should be placed so that the fuse will
not curl up and prematurely detonate the blasting cap crimped to
it. Failure to comply may cause death or permanent injury.
CHARACTERISTICS
2-59. The MDI is the project name given to a new family of nonelectric blasting caps, nonelectric boosters,
and associated items. MDIs supplement and partially replace the M7 nonelectric blasting cap, the M6
electric blasting cap, and the M700 time fuse. The snap-together MDI components simplify initiation
systems and some types of explosive priming. In some cases, emplacement times can be decreased by up to
50 percent. MDIs also improve reliability and safety. One reason for this reliability is the fact that all of the
components are sealed and, unlike standard nonelectric-priming components, cannot be easily degraded by
moisture. However, once the system has been spliced, reliability is significantly degraded due to moisture.
The sealed MDI components can be emplaced 70 feet underwater.
SHOCK TUBE
2-60. The shock tube is a thin, plastic tube of extruded polymer with a dusting of cyclotetramethylene
tetramitramine (HMX) and aluminum powder deposited on its interior surface. This special explosive dust
propagates a detonation wave. The wave moves along the shock tube to a factory crimped and sealed
blasting cap (which is moisture resistant). The detonation is normally contained within the plastic tubing,
and if strands of tubing touch or cross over each other there is no concern that an inadvertent ignition would
occur. Fragments from blasting caps or other explosive charges travel at speeds three to five times faster
than the detonating wave in the shock tube. These fragments could cause damage to other shock tube
assemblies. Any puncture in the shock tube in front of the dust explosion provides a path for the explosive
wave to vent. The shock tube offers the instantaneous action of electric initiation without the risk of
accidental initiation of the blasting cap (and the charge) by radio transmitters in the area or by static
electricity discharge. The shock tube medium is extremely reliable.
WARNING
Although the detonation along the shock tube is normally
contained within the blasting tubing, burns may occur if the
shock tube is held. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
Note. To prevent misfire, MDIs used at high altitude must be precut and a temporary moisture
seal applied to the ends before moving from low altitude to high altitude. This action prevents
the HMX from escaping the shock tube when cut at high altitudes due to the air pressure
difference between the inside of the shock tube and the surrounding atmosphere.
WARNING
Never attach an M81 until ready to attach the system. Failure to
comply could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
2-61. Shock tube functioning is usually evident by a bright flash within the tube. The flash is well
contained by the olive drab coating but can be seen in the clear coating of military shock tubes. The flash
can produce a burn if a piece of shock tube is held when it is functioning, even through the coating of the
shock tube. Therefore, never hold a shock tube while detonating an explosive system. The free end of the
shock tube blasting cap is always sealed. Cutting the shock tube exposes the open ends to moisture and
should only be done if absolutely necessary. Dampening the explosive dust on the inside of the shock tube
will stop a detonation from going beyond such a damp spot. Care should be used when cutting shock tubes.
When cutting a shock tube, a sharp knife or other single blade should be used to produce a square cut.
Never use pliers, crimpers, or scissors when cutting shock tube because they will cause narrowing of the
small diameter hole in the shock tube. Any narrowing or overlapping of the hole could block the explosive
path and result in a failure to ignite the explosive dust in the shock tube.
BLASTING CAPS
2-62. Military explosives require a substantial shock to be initiated. This shock is provided by a high-
strength blasting cap (nonelectric M7 or the electric M6). To replace the M6 and M7, there are high-
strength and low-strength MDI blasting caps. Each blasting cap is factory crimped and sealed, making them
extremely reliable.
High-Strength Caps
2-63. High-strength caps include the M11, M14, M15, M18, M19, M21, and M23. All are nonelectric and
come with a length of shock tube attached. The function of the shock tube is to transfer a small initiating
impulse to the explosive end of the cap (an explosive-filled aluminum tube or detonator), which produces a
detonation shock strong enough to initiate military explosives. Cap characteristics are as follows:
コ The M11 cap comes with a 30-foot length of shock tube factory-attached to a military-sized
aluminum blasting cap tube. The M11 is essentially instantaneous in its action. The M11 has a
plastic connector on the free end of its shock tube called a detonating cord clip. The detonating
cord clip facilitates quick and easy attachment onto the detonating cord.
コ The M14 consists of a military strength and size nonelectric blasting cap, factory-crimped to a
factory-calibrated, nominal 5-minute length of M700 time-blasting fuse.
コ The M15 has pyrotechnic (used to introduce a delay into an explosive train because of its known
burning time [the definition was shortened, and the complete definition is printed in the
glossary]) (FM 1-02) (JP 1-02) devices installed to provide a small time delay between its
initiation and the firing of its detonators. The M15 has two detonators. One detonator is low
strength with a 25-millisecond delay, and the other is high strength with a 200-millisecond
delay.
コ The M18 consists of a military strength and size nonelectric blasting cap, factory-crimped to a
factory-calibrated, nominal 20-minute length of M700 time-blasting fuse.
コ The M19 consists of a 200-foot length of dual minitube with an in-line initiator built into one
end of each of the two minitubes and a nonelectric, nondelay high-strength blasting cap attached
to the other end of each minitube. The minitube is smaller in diameter and possesses all the same
characteristics of shock tube. The M81E1 igniter is attached to each in-line initiator.
コ The M21 consists of a high-strength blasting cap precrimped to a 500-foot length of minitube.
The M21 is about one-third the size and weight of the existing M12. The M81E1 igniter is
attached to the in-line initiator.
コ The M23 consists of a high-strength blasting cap precrimped to a 1,000-foot length of minitube.
The M23 is about one-third the size and weight of the existing M13. The M81E1 igniter is
attached to the in-line initiator.
Note. All high-strength caps will be in the original packaging or a protective foam cylinder when
carried by Soldiers.
Low-Strength Caps
2-64. The M12 and M13 are the two low-strength MDI blasting caps. These relay-type blasting caps come
with factory-attached lengths of shock tube (500 feet for the M12 and 1,000 feet for the M13). The
detonators of the relay-type caps are purposely made larger than standard military blasting caps (and the
high-strength MDI blasting caps) so they will not fit in standard cap wells. It is important to remember that
the low-strength, relay-type caps (such as the M12 and M13) cannot reliably set off standard military
explosives. However, low-strength caps of the MDI M12 and M13 will reliabily initiate detonating cord.
Boosters
2-65. The M151 is a nonelectric, insensitive initiation system that is factory-assembled. It is assembled by
crimping a secondary explosive booster onto a 10-foot length of low-strength detonating cord to allow the
user to preprime explosives for military operations and bury explosives primed with M151. The M151 has
a detonating cord clip like other MDI components for easy attachment to a line or ring main detonating
cord. A pentagonal-shaped tag affixed to the low-strength detonating cord identifies it as an M151 to
preclude incorrect connection within a firing system.
2-66. The M152 is a nonelectric, insensitive initiation system that is factory-assembled. It is assembled by
crimping a secondary explosive booster onto a 30-foot length of low-strength detonating cord to allow the
user to preprime explosives for military operations and bury explosives primed with M152. The M152 has
a detonating cord clip like other MDI components for easy attachment to a line or ring main detonating
cord. A pentagonal-shaped tag affixed to the low-strength detonating cord identifies it as an M152 to
preclude incorrect connection within a firing system.
M9 BLASTING-CAP HOLDER
2-67. Plastic holders allow the connection of several shock tubes to high-strength blasting caps and
boosters. The M9 holder helps secure the connection of up to five shock tubes or low-strength detonating
cord to high-strength caps or boosters. The M9 holder can also be used to connect high-strength blasting
caps and boosters to detonating cord. When using the M9 holder, tape it closed.
WARNING
Do not connect the shock tube, low-strength detonating cord, or
detonating cord in the same holder. Detonating cord functions at
a higher velocity than the HMX and aluminum in the shock tube
and may cause a break in the shock tube. Failure to comply could
result in immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
WARNING
Never attach detonating cord, an M151, or an M152 to the M81
igniter. Failure to comply could result in immediate personal
injury or damage to equipment.
USE
2-70. The M11 can be used to prime standard military explosives. The M11 can also be used to initiate
detonating cord or shock tube.
FUNCTIONS
2-71. The M11 functions by sending an initiating shock or small detonation through the shock tube to the
blasting cap. The shock tube itself must be initiated by a relay-type blasting cap, booster, or igniter (M81).
The M11’s detonation is instantaneous. See Table 2-1, page 2-36, for the M11 characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
Aluminum-tube detonator
Diameter 0.241 in
Material Various plastics
Shock tube Length 30 ft
Diameter 0.118 in
Lead azide, molybdenum chromate, RDX, or
Detonator
PETN
Filler Shock tube HMX and aluminum
Shock from the detonation of a blasting cap or
Actuation method
detonating cord
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping
Detonator assemblies, nonelectric for blasting
name
UN serial number 0500
NSN 1375-01-415-1232
DOT container marking DODAC Live: ML47 Inert: MN36
NEW
19 gr
(per cap)
Specification QAA-1423
Packaging 60 units per wood box; 16 boxes per pallet
Dimensions 20.5 by 13 by 25.75 in
Cube 2.8 cu ft
Packing box
NEW 0.16 lb
Gross weight of
49 lb
package
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
Figure 2-37. M12 Shock Tube Component and Blasting Cap With a Splicing Kit
USE
2-73. The M12 is used as a transmission line in a firing system. It does not have enough output to initiate
military explosives reliably.
FUNCTIONS
2-74. The M12 functions by sending an initiating shock or small detonation through the shock tube to the
blasting cap. This blasting cap then actuates five shock tubes, five low-strength detonating cords, or one
strand of high-strength detonating cord held by the plastic connector. The M12’s shock tube must be
initiated by another blasting cap or by the M81 fuse igniter. Table 2-2, page 2-38, shows the
M12characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Aluminum-tube Length 2.7 in
detonator
Diameter 0.296 in
Material Various plastics
Shock tube Length 500 ft
Diameter 0.118 in
Detonator Lead azide, PETN
cap with a protected ignition primer that is factory-installed to an in-line initiator on the minitube. The M21
has an M9 holder already connected to the high-strength cap (Figure 2-38).
Figure 2-38. M21 MDI With a 500-Foot Shock Tube Component With a Splicing Kit
USE
2-76. The M21 is used to transmit a shock tube detonation impulse from an initiator (or another relay cap).
Unlike the M12, a high-strength blasting cap or booster will not have to be added as part of the
transmission line. The M21 high-strength cap can be secured into an M9 holder to provide the capability to
initiate up to five additional shock tubes or five low-strength detonating cords or one strand of detonating
cord. The M21 high-strength cap can also be used to prime military explosives.
FUNCTIONS
2-77. The M21 functions by sending an initiating shock or small detonation through the shock tube to the
blasting cap. This blasting cap then actuates five shock tubes, five low-strength detonating cords, or one
strand of high-strength detonating cord held by the plastic connector. The M21’s shock tube must be
initiated by another blasting cap or by the M81E1 in-line initiators. Table 2-3, page 2-40, shows the M21
characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
Aluminum-tube detonator
Diameter 0.230 to 0.241 in
Material Various plastics
Shock tube Length 500 ft
Diameter 0.09 in
Detonator Lead azide, PETN
Filler Shock tube HMX and aluminum
Actuation method Impulse from attached minitube
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping name Detonating, assemblies, nonelectric
UN serial number 0500
NSN 1375-01-494-6945
DODAC Live: MN88 Inert: MN89
DOT container marking
NEW (per cap) 19 gr
Drawing 12999559
Specification QAA-1430
8 units per fiberboard box; 5 boxes per wooden
Packaging
box (40)
Dimensions 44 by 16.38 by 17.38 in
Cube 5.25 cu ft
Packing box
NEW 0.28 lb
Gross weight of package 20 lb
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
TM 9-1375-213-12
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
Figure 2-39. M13 Shock Tube Component and Blasting Cap With a Splicing Kit
USE
2-79. The M13 is used as a transmission line in a firing system. It does not have enough output to initiate
military explosives reliably.
FUNCTIONS
2-80. The M13 functions by sending an initiating shock or a small detonation through the shock tube to the
blasting cap. This blasting cap then actuates five shock tubes, five low-strength detonating cords, or one
strand of high-strength detonating cord held by the plastic connector. The M13’s shock tube must be
initiated by another blasting cap or by the M81 fuse igniter. Table 2-4, page 2-42, shows the M13
characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Length 2.7 in
Aluminum-tube detonator
Diameter 0.296 in
Material Various plastics
Shock tube Length 1,000 ft
Diameter 0.118 in
Detonator Lead azide, PETN
USE
2-82. The M23 is used to transmit a shock tube detonation impulse from an initiator (or another relay cap).
Unlike the M13, a high-strength blasting cap or booster will not have to be added as part of the
transmission line. The M23 high-strength cap can be secured into an M9 holder to provide the capability to
initiate up to five additional shock tubes or five low-strength detonating cords or one strand of detonating
cord. The M23 high-strength cap can also be used to prime military explosives.
FUNCTIONS
2-83. The M23 functions by sending an initiating shock or small detonation through the shock tube to the
blasting cap. This blasting cap then actuates five shock tubes, five low-strength detonating cords, or one
strand of high-strength detonating cord held by the plastic connector. The M23’s shock tube must be
initiated by another blasting cap or by the M81E1 in-line initiators. Table 2-5, page 2-44, shows the M23
characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Aluminum-tube Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
detonator
Diameter 0.230 to 0.241 in
Material Various plastics
Shock tube Length 1,000 ft
Diameter 0.09 in
Detonator Lead azide, PETN
Filler Shock tube HMX and aluminum
Actuation method Impulse from attached minitube
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping name Detonating, assemblies, nonelectric
UN serial number 0500
NSN 1375-01-494-6941
DODAC Live: MN90 Inert: none
DOT container marking
NEW (per cap) 19 gr
Drawing 12999561
Specification QAA-1430
4 units per fiberboard box; 5 boxes per wooden
Packaging
box (20); 4 wooden boxes per pallet (80)
Dimensions 44 by 16.38 by 17.38 in
Cube 5.25 cu ft
Packing box
NEW 0.22 lb
Gross weight of package 17 lb
References
TM 9-1375-213-12
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
USE
2-85. The M14 is used to detonate military explosives and initiate shock tube, low-strength detonating
cord, and detonating cord after being ignited. In dual initiation, an M14 can be connected to a line main or
transmission line and be used as the primary or secondary initiation system.
FUNCTIONS
2-86. The M14 functions by sending an initiating flame (from a time-blasting fuse igniter or a match)
slowly through the length of the time-blasting fuse to the blasting cap. The 1-minute bands on the time fuse
have been factory-calibrated. The burn time will increase with altitude and colder temperatures. The M14
has been designed to allow a nominal 5-minute delay, under all weather and altitude conditions, to allow
personnel to move to the minimum safe distance (MSD) from the explosive charges being detonated. If
greater time accuracy is required under specific altitude and weather conditions, an M14 from the same lot
should be tested. The M14 being tested should be timed to the detonation of the cap to provide an actual
burn time. This will allow the operator to adjust the time for the detonation of the explosive system or main
charge. Table 2-6, page 2-46, shows the M14 characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
Aluminum-tube detonator
Diameter 0.230 to 0.241 in
Material Plastic-covered fiber
Time-blasting fuse Length About 7.5 ft
Diameter 0.25 in
Detonator Lead styphnate, lead azide, PETN
Filler Time fuse Black powder
Actuation method M81 fuse igniter or flame from a match
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping name Detonators, nonelectric
Pre-1999: 0455
UN serial number
Post-1999: 0500
Pre-1999 production: 1375-01-415-1233
NSN
Post-1999 production: 1375-01-482-7380
DODAC Live: MN06 Inert: MN37
DOT container marking Pre-1999 production: 16 gr
NEW (per cap)
Post-1999 production: 16 gr
Drawing 12982929
Specification QAA-1424B
Pre-1999 production: 10 units per fiberboard
box; 6 boxes per wooden box (60)
Packaging
Post-1999 production: 10 units per fiberboard
box; 4 boxes per wooden box (40)
Dimensions 26 by 18 by 11 in
Cube 2.8 cu ft
Packing box Pre-1999 production: 1.554 lb
NEW
Post-1999 production: 1.6 lb
Pre-1999 production: 57 lb
Gross weight of package
Post-1999 production: 86 lb
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
USE
2-88. The M18 is used to detonate all standard military explosives. It is also used to initiate shock tube
blasting caps and detonating cord up to 20 minutes after being ignited.
FUNCTIONS
2-89. The M18 functions by sending an initiating flame (from a fuse igniter or a match) slowly through the
length of the time-blasting fuse to the factory-crimped blasting cap. The 1-minute bands on the time fuse
have been calibrated at sea level at a temperature of 125°F. The burn time will increase with altitude and
colder temperatures. The M18 has been designed to allow a nominal 20-minute delay under all weather and
altitude conditions. This allows personnel to move to the MSD from the emplaced explosive charges being
detonated. Table 2-7, page 2-48, shows the M18 characteristics.
Tabulated Data
DANGER
The M15 can only be used belowground in quarry operations
according to FM 3-34.465. Failure to comply may cause death or
permanent injury.
USE
2-91. The M15 is used to provide a delay element in a combination firing system to obtain staged
detonations. Delayed and staged detonations are essential in quarrying operations but are also used in
relieved-face cratering.
FUNCTIONS
2-92. The M15 sends an initiating shock (or small detonation) through the shock tube to both of the
blasting caps. These contain pyrotechnic-delay elements. The delay times in the two detonators are
different; one is 25 milliseconds (low-strength, smaller cap with a shock tube connector), and the other is
200 milliseconds (higher-strength, larger cap with a shock tube connector). The high-strength blasting cap
is slightly larger in diameter than a standard blasting cap and will not fit in a standard cap well. The M15
shock tube must be initiated by another MDI component. Table 2-8, page 2-50, shows the M15
characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Length (low strength) 2.5 in
Length (high strength) 3.5 in
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
preprime explosives for military operations and bury explosives primed with M151. The M151 has a
detonating cord clip like other MDI components for easy attachment to a line or ring main detonating cord.
A pentagonal-shaped tag affixed to the low-strength detonating cord identifies it as an M151 to preclude
incorrect connection within a firing system.
CAUTION
Do not use M151 low-strength detonating cord as a line or ring main.
The M151 is only used as a branchline and cannot be substituted for
standard detonating cord. Personal injury or damage to equipment
may result from long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
USE
2-94. The M151 is used to prime charges in situations where simultaneous initiation and detonation are
desired. Prepriming of charges allows a Soldier to transport the preprimed charge in the vehicle or on his
person. This also allows for the burial of an explosive charge.
WARNING
Never attach an M60 or M81 igniter to the M151. Failure to comply
could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
FUNCTIONS
2-95. The M151 functions upon receiving an initiating shock from a blasting cap or other booster. When
the booster functions, it detonates the primed explosive charge. The M151 booster can be secured in the
M9 holder by using the small flap. Table 2-9, page 2-52, shows the M151 characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Material PETN
Aluminum-tube booster
cap Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
Diameter 0.230 to 0.241 in
Black fiber, with an environmental seal on one end,
Material
5 to 7.5 gr per ft
Green pentagonal-shaped identification tag on both
ends of the assembly, marked M151 to distinguish a
Marking
low-strength detonating cord from other MDI
Low-strength detonating components
cord
Length 10 ft
Diameter 0.150 in
Shock from the detonation of a blasting cap or
Actuation method detonating cord when an M151 is used as a
branchline
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping name Detonator, assemblies, nonelectric
UN serial number 0410
NSN 1375-01-467-8646
DODAC Live: MN68 Inert: none
DOT container marking
NEW 87 gr
Drawing D10451-1 Ensign-Bickford drawing
Specification None
Packaging 20 per cardboard box; 6 boxes per overpack (120)
Dimensions None
Cube None
Packing box
NEW 1.13 lb
Gross weight of package 46 lb
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
A pentagonal-shaped tag affixed to the low-strength detonating cord identifies it as an M152 to preclude
incorrect connection within a firing system (Figure 2-44).
CAUTION
Do not use M152 low-strength detonating cord as a line or ring main.
The M152 is only used as a branchline and cannot be substituted for
standard detonating cord. Personal injury or damage to equipment
may result from long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
USE
2-97. The M152 is used to prime charges in situations where simultaneous initiation and detonation are
desired. Prepriming of charges allows a Soldier to transport the preprimed charge in the vehicle or on his
person. This also allows for the burial of an explosive charge.
WARNING
Never attach an M60 or M81 igniter to the M152. Failure to comply
could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
FUNCTIONS
2-98. The M152 functions upon receiving an initiating shock from a blasting cap or other booster. When
the booster functions, it detonates the primed explosive charge. The M152 booster can be secured in the
M9 holder by using the small flap. Table 2-10, page 2-54, shows the M152characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Material PETN
Aluminum-tube booster
cap Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
Diameter 0.230 to 0.241 in
Black fiber, with an environmental seal on one end,
Material
5 to 7.5 gr per ft
Green pentagonal-shaped identification tag on
Marking
both ends of the assembly, marked as M152
Low-strength detonating
cord Length 30 ft
Diameter 0.150 in
Shock from the detonation of a blasting cap or
Actuation method detonating cord when an M152 is used as a
branchline
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping name Detonator, assemblies, nonelectric
UN serial number 0410
NSN Live: 1375-01-470-2399 Inert: 1375-01-467-8645
DODAC Live: MN69 Inert: MN75
DOT container marking
NEW 197 gr
Drawing D10451-2 Ensign-Bickford drawing
Specification None
Packaging 20 per cardboard box; 3 boxes per overpack (60)
Dimensions None
Cube None
Packing box
NEW 1.44 lb
Gross weight of package 46 lb
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
USE
2-100. The M19 is used to initiate standard military explosives and demolition charges by inserting the
blasting caps directly into an explosive or the cap well of demolition charges. The M19 is particularly
suited for urban terrain missions when very high reliability is required.
FUNCTIONS
2-101. The M19s minitube must be initiated by a blasting cap or by activating the firing assembly of the
M81E1 igniter. To actuate the M81E1, remove the cotter pin, and then pull the pull ring to the limit of its
travel. The pull ring rod then releases the firing pin. The firing assembly of the M81E1 igniter strikes the
M42C1 primer. The small detonation impulse (shock wave) from the primer is transmitted through the
minitube into a less sensitive explosive contained within its blasting cap. The blasting cap can actuate an
additional number of components held by the M9 plastic holder or can directly initiate explosive charges or
demolition devices. Table 2-11, page 2-56, shows the M19 characteristics.
Tabulated Data
Aluminum-tube Length 2.25 to 2.35 in
detonator
Diameter 0.230 to 0.241 in
Material Various plastics
Shock tube Length 200 ft (dual)
Diameter 0.09 in
Detonator Lead azide, RDX
Filler Shock tube HMX and aluminum
Actuation method Impulse from attached minitube
Shipping and Storage Data
DOD hazard class
1.4S
QD/DIV/SCG
DOT hazard class 1.4S
DOT label Explosive 1.4S
Proper shipping name Detonating assemblies, nonelectric
UN serial number 500
NSN 1375-01-494-6939
DODAC Live: MN86 Inert: MN87
DOT container marking
NEW (per cap) 18 gr
Drawing 12999557
Specification QAA-1431
Packaging 8 per fiberboard box; 5 boxes per wooden box (40)
Dimensions 44 by 16 by 21.5 in
Cube 8.76 cu ft
Packing box
NEW 0.31 lb
Gross weight of package 20 lb
References
TM 9-1375-213-12
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
Note. Do not connect the shock tube, low-strength detonating cord, or detonating cord in the
same holder. Detonating cord functions at a higher velocity than the HMX and aluminum in the
shock tube and may cause a break in the shock tube.
1 to 2 shock tubes
Overhand knot
USE
2-103. The M9 can accommodate and ensure proper proximity for initiating up to five shock tubes, five
low-strength detonating cords, or one strand of detonating cord from the blasting cap or booster. The M9
can also be used to connect the MDI blasting cap or booster to a detonating cord line or a ring main.
FUNCTIONS
2-104. Shock tubes must be positioned straight through the holder with an overhand knot when using one
or more (Figure 2-46). The blasting cap or booster is inserted and secured by closing the smaller hinged
flap. Insert the ends of the shock tubes through the channels in the holder. Close the large flap to secure the
overhand knot. Use tape to secure the large flap in place. See Table 2-12, page 2-58, for the M9
characteristics. In the event an M9 holder becomes unserviceable or is not available, use tape to make MDI
connections. To attach a blasting cap to MDI components using tape, ensure that all strands of shock tube
or low-strength detonating cord being connected are in contact with the blasting cap or booster and is
secured with tape.
Tabulated data
Length 3.0 in
Diameter 1.3 in
Thickness 0.7 in
One cap or booster per five shock tubes on
Accommodation
low-strength detonating cords
Material Polyethylene
Color Black
Dimensions (closed)
NSN 1375-01-415-1229
DODAC 1375-ML45
Drawing 12972626
Specification QAA-1423
Gross weight of item 1 oz
Packaging 500 units per box
Gross weight of package 49 lb
Because this item is designed for one-time use, continued use in training will
Limitations
wear out the hinges very quickly.
WARNING
Never attach an M151, M152, or detonating cord to the M81
igniter. Failure to comply could result in immediate personal
injury or damage to equipment.
USE
2-106. The M81 igniter is used to ignite a time-blasting fuse or to initiate a shock tube.
Note. The standard M60 igniter (which has an almost identical appearance to the M81) will not
secure or reliably initiate the shock tube.
FUNCTIONS
2-107. The M81 is actuated as follows:
コ Loosen the screw cap and remove the shipping plug when using shock tube. Remove both the
shipping plug and shock tube reducer when using a time fuse (Figure 2-47).
コ Insert the freshly cut end of the time-blasting fuse or shock tube in the hole from which the plugs
were removed.
コ Tighten the screw cap to secure the fuse or shock tube.
コ Remove the safety (cotter) pin by squeezing the safety pin ends together then pulling on the
cord.
コ Pull the pull ring to the limit of its travel.
Note. When the M81 reaches its limit of travel, the pull ring rod releases the firing pin. The
spring forces the pin into the primer. The primer fires with a flame, and an explosive shock
ignites the fuse or initiates the shock tube.
Tabulated Data
Length 4.0 in
References
TM 9-1375-213-34&P
DOD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
2-109. There are three methods of priming explosive charges—nonelectric (MDI), boosters (MDI), and
detonating cord. Only nonelectric (MDI) and boosters are discussed in this section. Priming charges with
MDI M151 or MDI M152 components or detonating cord are the preferred methods for reserve demolition
targets, which allow charges to be primed at state of readiness—state 1 (safe).
NONELECTRIC PRIMING
2-110. Use high-strength MDI blasting caps or boosters for priming explosive charges that are emplaced
aboveground. For priming explosive charges belowground, use the M151 or M152 booster. Use the M12
and M13 only as transmission lines in firing systems (refer to Section VI of this chapter).
WARNING
Do not insert blasting caps in explosive charges until ordered to
do so. Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury
or damage to equipment.
2-111. MDI priming is safer and more reliable than the current nonelectric cap priming methods. MDI
blasting caps and boosters are already factory-crimped to precut lengths of shock tube or time-blasting fuse.
Because the caps are sealed units, they are resistant to moisture and will not misfire in damp conditions.
However, once the system has been spliced, reliability will be significantly degraded due to moisture. Also,
the human factor of incorrect crimping is removed, making MDI blasting caps and boosters extremely
reliable. MDI blasting caps and boosters can be used with priming adapters or can be inserted directly into
the explosive charge and secured with tape. If using priming adapters, place them on high-strength blasting
caps and boosters as outlined in the note below.
Note. Older MlA4 priming adapters must be slid down the full length of the shock tube or low-
strength detonating cord to the high-strength blasting cap or booster. To slide the priming
adapter on the free end of the shock tube, it will be necessary to cut off the end of the shock tube
to remove the sealed end cap, and then slide the detonating cord clip off. The preferred priming
adapter is the M1A5 priming adapter, which has wider slots and can be placed over the shock
tube at a point near the blasting cap or booster.
MILITARY DYNAMITE
2-113. Military dynamite can be primed with MDI blasting caps or boosters using either the end- or side-
priming method. M2 crimpers or other nonsparking tools are used to make a cap well in one end of the
dynamite cartridge. If using the side-priming method, make the cap well in the side of the cartridge at one
end. The blasting cap or booster is inserted nearly parallel to the side of the cartridge. The explosive tip of
the cap should be near the middle of the cartridge. A blasting cap or booster is inserted into the cap well.
The shock tube, time fuse, or low-strength detonating cord is secured to the cartridge with tape to hold the
blasting cap or booster firmly in place (Figure 2-49). For quarry operations, see FM 3-34.465.
a blasting cap or booster into the hole produced by the M2 crimpers. Do not force the blasting cap or
booster if it does not fit; make the hole larger. The blasting cap or booster is anchored in the demolition
block by gently squeezing the composition C4 plastic explosive around the blasting cap or booster. The
blasting cap or booster is secured by tape in the charge (Figure 2-50).
WARNING
Do not use the low-strength detonating cord of the M151 or M152
to lower 40-pound cratering charges into the holes. Failure to
comply could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
Note. Charges will not be primed with blasting caps until the charges are placed on the target.
BANGALORE TORPEDO
2-117. The bangalore torpedo is primed using a blasting cap or a booster. Insert the blasting cap or
booster into the cap well in the end section of the charge, and secure it with a priming adapter. If a priming
adapter is not available, use tape to hold the blasting cap or booster firmly in place (Figure 2-52).
INITIATING SETS
2-118. All MDI blasting caps and boosters can be used to initiate shock tube. Only use blasting caps or
boosters to initiate detonating cord or to prime and initiate explosive charges directly. MDI initiating sets
are used to initiate instantly. An M12, M13, M19, M21, and M23 or an M14 or M18 can be used to create a
delay. When using a combination (command and delayed) initiation system on the MDI, the command
initiation will be the primary initiation system, and the delay initiation will be the secondary initiation
system.
Note. Cover the secondary-initiation system blasting cap to reduce fragmentation hazards of the
cap.
2-119. If the primary initiating system fails, the secondary initiating system will function and initiate the
system when the time fuse burns down to the blasting cap. If the primary initiates the system, the secondary
blasting cap will detonate along with the other components of the firing system if it was connected to the
detonating cord. If the secondary blasting cap was connected to the shock tube or the low-strength
detonating cord, it will detonate when the time fuse burns down to the blasting cap. When using dual-delay
initiation systems, the shorter delay is the primary initiation system. When placing multiple charges, the
transmission line blasting caps and charges should be a sufficient distance apart to prevent fragments from
cutting other shock tube or low-strength detonating cord components before their planned ignition.
WARNING
Always observe the safe distances given in Chapter 6. Failure to
comply could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
WARNING
Crimpers will not make a smooth enough cut to ensure that the
M81 will function the shock tube. Failure to comply could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
コ Push the shock tube into the hole in the M81 end cap as far as it will go. Turn the igniter end cap
clockwise and finger tight to secure it in the device once the shock tube has seated (Figure 2-53,
page 2-66).
コ Ensure that all friendly personnel are at a safe distance from the explosive charge and that they
take appropriate cover.
コ Squeeze together the spread legs of the safety (cotter) pin. Use the safety pin cord to remove the
safety pin from the body of the igniter. Wear a leather glove, and grasp the igniter body firmly
with one hand, with the pull ring fully accessible to the other hand.
コ Actuate the igniter by sharply pulling its pull ring. Ensure that the pop of the igniter primer is
heard.
Note. The mechanism of the M81 is identical to that of the old M60 igniter. If the primer does
not fire, the M81 can be recocked and reactuated immediately. The igniter should be held firmly
and then the pull rod should be pushed back into the igniter until a click is heard or felt, and then
the pull ring should be pulled again sharply to actuate it. If the igniter primer fires, but the charge
does not, refer to Section VII, Misfires, in this chapter.
DELAY INITIATION
2-121. The M14 delay blasting cap assembly has a 7 1/2-foot length of time fuse marked in nominal
1-minute increments giving a total delay of a nominal 5 minutes. Before attaching the M14 to the initiation
system, visually inspect the initiating sets for possible misfire problems. This is the only test procedure for
the MDI initiating set. The M14 is initiated by—
コ Step 1. Opening an M9 blasting cap holder.
コ Step 2. Inserting the M14 blasting cap.
コ Step 3. Snapping shut the smaller hinged flap to secure the M14.
コ Step 4. Placing up to five shock tubes, five low-strength detonating cords, or one strand of
detonating cord in the M9 holder if they are run straight through the M9 and are not looped.
コ Step 5. Tying the shock tube, low-strength detonating cord, or detonating cord ends into an
overhand knot.
コ Step 6. Placing the shock tube, low-strength detonating cord, or detonating cord in the M9
holder alongside the blasting cap and securing the M9 larger hinged holder flap.
コ Step 7. Securing the large flap with tape (Figure 2-54).
Figure 2-55. M81 Fuse Igniter With an M14 Time Fuse Installed
SPECIAL CONDITIONS
2-123. The ambient temperature and the altitude of the site have an impact on the operation of the MDI.
Cold weather and high altitudes will extend the delay times on the M14 and M18. Precautions can be taken
when using MDI in extreme cold temperatures and/or high altitudes by dual-priming and dual-initiating the
charges to ensure proper initiation. When using MDI for ice demolitions, the same precautions must be
taken with one addition; if the charges are to be placed in the ice or under water in extreme cold conditions,
the same rules apply as if the target were stemmed or tamped. For these types of missions, use detonating
cord for priming and branchline construction.
Note. The M14 and M18 time-blasting fuses gives about a 5-minute delay and 20-minutes,
respectively, between lighting the fuse and initiating the detonator. Like the standard M700 fuse,
the burning time will vary with temperature and altitude. For example, operating at an altitude of
12,000 feet in cold weather will extend the delay time significantly. When exact detonation
times are required, command-detonation methods should be considered.
WARNING
When using an MDI in extreme cold temperatures and/or high
altitudes, dual-prime and dual-initiate the charges. Failure to
comply could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
DISPOSAL
2-125. After the charges have been successfully fired, the unit commander is responsible for ensuring the
proper disposal of the residue. The used shock tube is nonrecyclable plastic and may be sent directly to an
approved landfill. However, the blasting cap residual is considered hazardous waste and must be removed
from the shock tube and disposed of according to local policy. Commanders must coordinate with the local
Directorate of Engineering (Department of Public Works) and/or the local Defense Reutilization and
Marketing Office (DRMO) for local disposal guidance and landfill information.
WARNING
Do not dispose of used shock tubes by burning them because of
the potentially toxic fumes given off from the burning plastic.
Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury or
damage to equipment.
STAND-ALONE SYSTEM
2-126. The stand-alone firing system is one in which the initiating sets and transmission and branchlines
are constructed using only MDI components and the explosive charges are primed with MDI blasting caps
or boosters. It is important to ensure that the firing system is balanced. All charges must have the same
distance in the shock tube length and the low-strength detonating cord from the firing point to the charge.
Figure 2-56 shows the MDI single-firing system and Figure 2-57, page 2-70, shows the MDI dual-firing
system.
2-127. The disadvantages of a single-firing system are that if the transmission line is cut, charges down
line from the cut will not detonate. If there is a possibility of the transmission lines being cut (for example,
through artillery fires), a second firing system should be added as shown in Figure 2-57.
WARNING
When making multishock tube installations, ensure that the shock
tubes are protected from the effects of the nearby relay caps and
charges. The shrapnel produced by a cap or charge could easily
cause a misfire (partial or complete). When there are many shock
tubes involved in a shot, they should be carefully placed away
from the junction. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
2-128. The stand-alone MDI firing system is used for all types of demolition missions, including bridge
demolitions. The MDI firing system can be used to initiate reserved demolition targets. However, only the
M151 or M152 may be used to prime charges. Under current internationally agreed upon doctrine, charges
cannot be primed with blasting caps until a change of readiness from state 1 (safe) to state 2 (armed) is
ordered. Priming every charge with MDI blasting caps at this critical moment would take a considerable
amount of time and be unacceptable to the maneuver commander. Priming charges with MDI M151 or
MDI M152 components or detonating cord are the required methods for reserve demolition targets. The
charges in this case are now dual-primed, the transmission line is laid in the opposite direction of the first
transmission line, and the system is a balanced system.
Note. To effectively prevent a misfire, the shock wave in the shock tube must travel the same
distance to all charges. No more than five M11, M151, or M152 branchlines can be connected to
the transmission line blasting cap holder. If there are more than five charges, group the
branchlines from the charges, and connect them to the M9s blasting cap holder of another M11,
M151, or to an M152 branchline. The branchline is connected to the transmission line blasting-
cap holder as shown in Figure 2-46, page 2-57. The transmission and branchlines are secured by
a large, hinged flap and the flap is secured with tape.
コ Step 6. Perform a visual inspection of the firing system for possible misfire indicators while en
route to the firing point.
コ Step 7. Initiate the system at the firing point using the procedures in paragraph 2-121.
Figure 2-59. Combination (MDI and Detonating Cord) Firing System (Dual)
2-133. Use the combination (MDI and detonating cord) firing system for all types of demolition missions.
It combines the advantages of MDI components with the simplicity and flexibility of detonating cord. The
combination firing system is the preferred method for reserved demolition targets, underwater operations,
and operations where subsurface-laid charges are used.
Note. M151s or M152s can be used to replace detonating cord when used as branchlines to
charges placed either aboveground or belowground.
コ Step 1. Identify the firing point, and observe the safe distances as given in Chapter 6.
コ Step 2. Emplace and secure the primed explosive charges on the target.
コ Step 3. Construct detonating cord line or ring mains according to the procedures in Section III,
of this chapter.
コ Step 4. Cover the blasting cap of the transmission line with a sandbag or another easily
identifiable marker at the connection between the detonating cord line and ring main to the MDI
initiating set.
コ Step 5. Tie in any detonating cord branchlines to the line or ring main. Clip the branchlines to
the detonating cord line or ring main using the attached detonating cord clip if priming with
MDI. Do this by—
ト Looping the shock tube around and into the detonating cord clip (Figure 2-60).
ト Pulling the shock tube tight to prevent the detonating cord clip from slipping.
ト Clipping the detonating cord line or ring main into the detonating cord clip.
ト Laying the branchlines toward the charges if an M11 is used.
Note. A fully sealed MDI component should be used to replace the broken shock tube. If a fully
sealed MDI component is not available, splicing is used as a last resort. When conducting water
or diving demolition missions, do not splice the shock tube.
2-136. The following procedures are the proper way to splice the shock tube:
コ Step 1. Use a sharp knife to make a square cut about 3 feet from the previously cutoff end of the
shock tube, whether or not it was knotted according to the guidance above. Immediately seal off
the shock tube remaining on the spool by bending 2 inches of the shock tube end over on itself
and taping it in place to provide a temporary moisture seal. Tie a knot if no tape is available.
コ Step 2. Tie loosely the two shock tube ends to be spliced together in an overhand knot. Leave at
least 2 inches free at the end of each shock tube beyond the knot.
コ Step 3. Pull the shock tube lightly to tighten the knot, but not so tight as to significantly deform
the shock tube in the knot.
コ Step 4. Push one of the free shock tube ends to be spliced firmly into one of the precut splicing
tubes at least 1/4 inch.
コ Step 5. Push the other shock tube end firmly into the other end of the splicing tube at least
1/4 inch (Figure 2-61).
Note. It is not necessary for the two ends of the shock tube to meet; the detonation wave in the
shock tube will still generate over a small gap.
CAUTION
Taping two cut ends of the shock tube together does not make a
reliable splice. Personal injury or damage to equipment may result
from long-term failure to follow correct procedures.
DANGER
Do not handle misfires down range until the required 30-minute
waiting period for both primary and secondary initiation systems
has elapsed and other safety precautions have been taken.
Failure to comply may cause death or permanent injury.
2-140. The most common cause of a misfire in a shock tube firing system is the initiating element, usually
an M81 igniter. The following misfire procedures are for both command-initiated and delay-initiated
systems(Figure 2-62):
コ A failure with the M81 will occur if the primer does not fire. If, after two retries, the M81 does
not result in it firing, cut the shock tube, replace the igniter with a new one, and repeat the firing
procedure.
コ Another misfire mode for the M81 is that the primer fires but blows the shock tube out of its
securing mechanism without it firing. This is usually due to the shock tube not having been
properly inserted and secured in the igniter. To correct this problem, cut a minimum of 3 feet
from the end of the shock tube. It is recommended that the shock tube be checked for the
presence of fine explosive powder following step 1 in the next paragraph. If powder is present,
replace the igniter and repeat the firing procedure.
DANGER
Never yank or pull hard on the shock tube. This may actuate the
blasting cap. Failure to comply may cause death or permanent
injury.
コ Step 6. If the first component of the firing train was not the one that failed, check out each
succeeding component until the failed one is found. Then, replace the failed or fired relay
components back to the initiating site as in steps 4 and 5.
コ Step 7. If the failed component appears to be the final high-strength blasting cap or booster,
replace if it is easily accessible. If it is used to prime an explosive charge, do not disturb it. Then,
place a new, primed 1-pound explosive charge next to the misfired charge and detonate it when
it is safe to do so.
コ Step 8. If the charges were primed with MDI M151 or MDI M152 components and buried,
follow the above misfire procedures to the low-strength detonating cord of an MDI M151 or
MDI M152. If the transmission line blasting cap has failed to function, use a nonsparking tool to
cut the low-strength detonating cord 1 foot past the failed transmission line blasting cap. Then,
walk back 10 feet from the defective blasting cap, and cut the transmission line shock tube.
Remove the defective shock tube, failed cap, and the length of low-strength detonating cord is
and dispose of them according to local misfire procedures. Lay out a replacement transmission
line to the firing point and then connect the remaining low-strength detonating cord to the
transmission line holder. Repeat the firing sequence to detonate the charge. If the buried charge
has failed to detonate, but the booster cord has functioned to the surface of the buried charge,
follow the procedures in Chapter 6, Section III.
STEEL-CUTTING CHARGES
2-144. Steel-cutting charges should be emplaced according to the procedures outlined in Chapter 3. See
Figure 2-63 for an example of steel I beam cutting charges.
TIMBER-CUTTING CHARGES
2-147. Timber-cutting charges should be emplaced and primed according to the procedures outlined in
Chapter 3.
WARNING
Do not use MDI shock tube components for priming internal
charges. Use the M151 or M152. Failure to comply could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
2-149. Figure 2-67 shows internal timber charges with dual initiation. The following steps are used when
placing internal timber charges:
コ Step 1. Place primed explosives according to the procedures outlined in Chapter 3.
コ Step 2. Lay out transmission lines from the charge to the firing point.
コ Step 3. Lay out branchlines.
コ Step 4. Tie the branchlines into the line main.
コ Step 5. Construct the line main according to the procedures outlined in Chapter 2.
コ Step 6. Connect the transmission line to the line main using an M9 holder, and tape it closed.
BREACHING CHARGES
2-150. Breaching charges are emplaced according to the procedures outlined in Chapter 3. See
Figure 2-68.
SECTION I – DEMOLITIONS
DEMOLITION PRINCIPLES
3-1. The amount and placement of explosives are key factors in military demolition projects. Formulas
are available to help an engineer calculate the required amount of explosives. Demolition principles and
critical-factor analysis guide a Soldier in working with explosive charges. The available formulas for
demolition calculations are based on the detonation effects, the charge dimension significance, and the
charge-placement significance.
DETONATION EFFECTS
3-2. When an explosive detonates, it violently changes into highly compressed gas. The explosive type,
density, confinement, and dimensions determine the rate at which the charge changes to a gaseous state.
The resulting pressure then forms a compressive shock wave that shatters and displaces objects in its path.
A HE charge detonated in direct contact with a solid object produces the following three detectable,
destructive effects:
コ Deformation. The shock wave charge deforms the surface of the object directly under the
charge. When the charge is placed on a concrete surface, it causes a compressive shock wave
that crumbles the concrete in the immediate vicinity of the charge, forming a crater. When
placed on a steel surface, the charge causes an indentation or depression about the size of the
charge contact area.
コ Spalling. The shock wave of the charge chips away at the surface of the object directly under the
charge. This action is known as spalling. If the charge is large enough, it will spall the opposite
side of the object. Because of the difference in density between the target and the air, the
compressive shock wave of the charge reflects as a tensile shock wave from the free surface if
the target has a free surface on the side opposite the charge. This action causes spalling of the
target-free surface. The crater and spalls may meet to form a hole through the wall in concrete
demolitions. On a steel plate, the charge may create one spall in the shape of the explosive
charge, throwing the spall from the plate.
コ Radial cracking. If the charge is large enough, the expanding gases can create a pressure load
on the object that will cause cracking and displacing of material. This effect is known as radial
cracking. When placed on concrete walls, the charge may crack the surface into a large number
of chunks and project them away from the center of the explosion. When placed on steel plates,
the charge may bend the steel away from the center of the explosion.
the target will be too much for the resulting shock wave. Additionally, a thick charge with too small a
contact area will transmit a shock wave over too small a target area with much lateral loss of energy.
CHARGE TYPES
3-5. Internal and external charges are the two charge types. Internal charges are charges that are placed in
boreholes in the target. External charges are charges that are placed on the surface of the target.
INTERNAL CHARGES
3-6. Internal charges are confined with tightly packed sand, wet clay, or other material (stemming).
Stemming is the process of packing material on top of an internal borehole or crater charge. Stemming
material is filled and tamped against the explosive to fill the borehole to the surface. In drilled holes, tamp
the explosive as it is loaded into the hole. Stemming material should be tamped only with a nonsparking
tool.
EXTERNAL CHARGES
3-7. External charges are covered and tamped with tightly packed sand, clay, or other dense material.
Stemming material may be loose or in sandbags. To be most effective, make the thickness of the tamping
material at least equal to the breaching radius. Small breaching charges are tamped on horizontal surfaces
with several inches of wet clay or mud.
the process is called tamping. Sandbags and earth are examples of common tamping materials.
Always tamp charges with a nonsparking tool.
コ Priming direction. The direction in which the shock wave travels through the explosive charge
will affect the rate of energy transmitted to the target. If the shock wave travels parallel to the
surface of the target (Figure 3-1, Diagram 1), the shock wave will transmit less energy over a
period of time than if the direction of detonation is perpendicular to the target (Figure 3-1,
Diagram 2). For best results, prime the charge in the center of the face farthest from the target.
Less than 5 1
5 to less than 40 2
40 to less than 300 4
300 or more 8
EXPLOSIVE SELECTIONS
3-9. Explosive selection for successful demolition operations is a balance between the factors listed in
paragraph 3-8 and the practical aspects; target type; the amount and types of explosives, materials (such as
sandbags), equipment, and personnel available; and the amount of time available to accomplish the
mission.
CHARGE CALCULATIONS
3-10. Use the six-step, problem-solving format below for all charge calculations. This format is used to
determine the weight (P) of the explosives required for a demolition task in pounds of TNT. If using an
explosive other than TNT, adjust P accordingly by dividing P for TNT by the relative effectiveness (RE)
factor of the explosive you plan to use (Table 1-1, pages 1-2 and 1-3).
コ Step 1. Determine the critical dimensions of the target.
コ Step 2. Calculate the weight of a single charge of TNT by using the appropriate demolition
formula.
コ Step 3. Divide the quantity of explosive by the RE factor. Skip this step if using TNT.
コ Step 4. Determine the number of packages of explosive for a single charge by dividing the
individual charge weight by the standard package weight of the chosen explosive. Round this
result to the next higher, whole package. Use volumes instead of weights for special-purpose
charges (ribbon, diamond, saddle, and similar charges).
コ Step 5. Determine the number of charges based on the targets.
コ Step 6. Determine the total quantity of explosives required to destroy the target by multiplying
the number of charges (step 5) by the number of packages required per charge (step 4).
TIMBER-CUTTING CHARGES
3-11. Plastic explosives are the best timber-cutting charges for both internal and external placement. These
explosives make excellent internal charges because they are easily tamped into boreholes. They make
excellent external charges, because they are easy to tie, tape, or fasten to the target. Timber will vary
widely in its physical properties from location to location, requiring careful calculation. Therefore, make
test shots on the specific timber type to determine the optimal size of the timber-cutting charge.
INTERNAL CHARGES
3-12. The following formula is used to calculate internal cutting charges:
D2
P= or P = 0.004D 2
250
where—
P = TNT required per tree (in pounds)
D = diameter or the least dimension of dressed timber (in inches)
For trees that are up to 18 inches in diameter, use one hole to place the explosive. For larger trees, use two
holes drilled at right angles to each other without intersecting but as close together as possible. Two-inch
diameter holes should be drilled to a depth equal to two-thirds of the diameter of the tree. Evenly split the
required charge between the holes. This will allow enough room to place the explosive in the holes and
leave enough room to cap them with mud or clay (Figure 3-2). For dimensioned timber requiring two
boreholes, place the boreholes side by side. When placing the charges, form the plastic explosive to the
approximate diameter of the hole. To not reduce the density of the explosive, try to minimize the amount of
molding. The charge is primed with detonating cord (see Chapter 2, Section II) and placed in the hole. A
nonsparking tool is used to finish filling the holes by packing them with mud or clay. When using two
boreholes, connect the branchlines in a British junction (Figure 2-33, page 2-29). For an example
calculation, see Appendix F (Figure F-1, page F-1).
EXTERNAL CHARGES
3-13. To be most effective, external charges should be rectangular, 1 to 2 inches thick, and twice as wide as
they are high. Remove the bark to place the explosive in direct contact with solid wood and to reduce air
gaps between the charge and the wood. If the timber is not round or if the direction of fall is not important,
place the explosive on the widest face. This will concentrate the force of the blast through the least
dimension of the timber. Trees will fall toward the side on which the explosive is placed, unless influenced
by the wind or the lean of the tree (Figure 3-3, page 3-6). If the tree is leaning the wrong way or a strong
wind is blowing, place a 1-pound kicker charge on the side opposite the main charge, about two-thirds of
the way up the tree. The kicker charge is fired at the same time as the main charge. For the best results
when using composition C4, orient the longest dimension of the charge horizontally. Orienting the charges
vertically tends to allow gaps to develop between the charges. Use the following formula to determine the
amount of explosive needed for cutting trees, posts, beams, or other timber using untamped external
charges. For an example calculation, see Figure F-2, page F-2.
D2
P= or P = 0.025D 2
40
where—
P = TNT required per target ( in pounds)
D = diameter or least dimension of dimensioned timber (in inches)
RING CHARGE
3-14. The ring charge is a band of explosives that completely encircles the tree (Figure 3-4). The explosive
band should be as wide as possible and at least 1/2 inch thick for small-diameter trees (up to 15 inches in
diameter) and 1 inch thick for medium- and large-diameter trees (up to 30 inches in diameter). Remove the
bark to place the explosive in direct contact with solid wood and to reduce air gaps between the charge and
the wood. Determine the amount of explosive necessary by using the external-charge formula. Prime the
ring charge in two opposing places with branchlines. Connect the branchlines in a British junction
(Figure 2-33, page 2-29).
UNDERWATER CHARGES
3-15. To cut a timber pile underwater, a method similar to the one shown in Figure 3-5 should be used. The
charge size is determined using the breaching formula. On the upstream side of the pile, the charge should
be placed as deep as possible. The stream flow on this part of the pile will maximize the tamping effect on
the explosive. If timber underwater is to be cut below mud or sand, engineer diver assets can be used to
water jet the soil away before charges are placed.
ABATIS
3-16. Fallen tree obstacles (Figure 3-6) are made by cutting trees that remain attached to their stumps.
Since trees vary in their physical properties, a test shot should be conducted if time and explosives are
available. The following formula is used to compute the amount of TNT required for the test shot:
D2
P= or P = 0.02D 2
50
where—
P = TNT required per tree (in pounds)
D = diameter or least dimension of dimensioned timber( in inches)
Placement
3-17. External placement should be used with the charge 5-feet aboveground level. The tree will fall
toward the side where the explosive is attached unless influenced by the lean of the tree or wind.
Special Considerations
3-18. The following should be considered when creating an abatis:
コ Place a 1-pound kicker charge on the side opposite the main charge, about two-thirds of the way
up the tree, if the tree is leaning the wrong way or a strong wind is blowing. Fire the kicker
charge at the same time as the main charge.
コ Ensure that the obstacle will cover at least 75 meters in depth.
コ Ensure that the individual trees are at least 2 feet in diameter. Smaller trees are not effective
obstacles against tracked vehicles.
コ Fell trees 3 to 5 meters apart to create a condition to prevent tracked vehicles from driving over
the top of the obstacle.
コ Fell the trees at a 45° angle toward the enemy.
コ Simultaneously detonate the charges on one side of the road at a time and then fell the trees on
the other side of the road.
コ Enhance the obstacle with the use of wire, mines, and booby traps.
Internal 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 3 3 4
External 1 1 2 3 4 5 7 9 11 14 17 20
Abatis — — — — — — — 7 9 11 14 16
Note. The packages required are rounded up to the next whole package.
STEEL-CUTTING CHARGES
WARNING
Steel-cutting charges produce metal fragments. Proper
precautions should be taken to protect personnel. Failure to
comply could result in immediate personal injury or damage to
equipment.
3-20. In order to prepare steel-cutting charges, the target factors and the explosive factors must be known.
The paragraphs below discuss the target and explosive factors.
TARGET FACTORS
3-21. Target configuration and target materials are critical in steel-structure demolitions, more so than with
other materials.
Target Configuration
3-22. The configuration of the steel in the structure determines the type and amount of charge necessary for
successful demolition. Examples of structured steel are I beams, wide-flange beams, channels, angle
sections, structural Ts, and steel plates used in building or bridge construction.
Target Materials
3-23. In addition to its configuration, steel also has a varied composition. It includes—
コ High-carbon steel. Metalworking dies and rolls are composed of high-carbon steel and are very
dense.
コ Alloy steel. Gears, shafts, tools, and plowshares are usually composed of alloy steel. Chains and
cables are often made from alloy steel; however, some chains and cables are composed of high-
carbon steel. Alloy steel is not as dense as high-carbon steel.
コ Cast iron. Some steel components (such as railroad rails and pipes) are composed of cast iron.
Cast iron is very brittle and easily broken.
コ Nickel-molybdenum steel. Nickel-molybdenum steel cannot be cut easily by conventional
steel-cutting charges. The jet from a shaped charge will penetrate it, but cutting requires multiple
charges or linear-shaped charges. Nickel-molybdenum steel shafts can be cut with a diamond
charge, but not with the saddle charge. Therefore, use some method other than explosives to cut
nickel-molybdenum steel, such as thermite, acetylene, or electrical cutting tools.
EXPLOSIVE FACTORS
3-24. In steel-cutting charges, the type, placement, and size of the explosive are important. Confining or
tamping the charge is rarely practical or possible. The type, placement, and size are factors that are
important when selecting steel-cutting charges.
Type
3-25. Plastic explosive (composition C4) and sheet explosive are the best explosives for steel cutting.
These explosives have very effective cutting power and are easily cut and shaped to fit tightly into the
grooves and angles of the target. These explosives are particularly effective when demolishing structural
steel, chains, and steel cables.
Placement
3-26. See Figure 3-7. To achieve the most effective initiation and results, ensure that—
コ The charge is continuous over the complete line of the proposed cut.
コ There is close contact between the charge and the target.
コ The width of the cross section charge is between one and three times its thickness. Do not use
charges more than 6 inches thick, because better results can be achieved by increasing the width
rather than the thickness.
コ The long charges are primed every 4 to 5 feet. If butting composition C4 packages end-to-end
along the line of the cut, prime every fourth package.
コ The direction of initiation is perpendicular to the target (Figure 3-1, page 3-3).
Size
3-27. The size of the charge is dictated by the type and size of the steel I beam and the charge type
selected. Either composition C4 or TNT block explosives can be used for the cutting steel; composition C4
works the best. Each steel configuration requires a unique charge size.
Block Charge
3-28. The following formula will give you the charge size necessary for cutting I beams, built-up girders,
steel plates, columns, and other structural steel sections. When calculating cutting charges for steel beams,
the area for the top flange, web, and the bottom flange should be calculated. Built-up beams have rivet
heads and angles or welds joining the flanges to the web. The thickness of one rivet head and the angle iron
must be added to the flange thickness when determining the thickness of a built-up beam flange. The
thinnest point of the web is used as the web thickness (the rivet head and angle iron thickness should be
ignored). The lattice of lattice girder webs are cut diagonally by placing a charge on each lattice along the
line of the cut. Use Table 3-3 and Table 3-4, page 3-12, to determine the correct amount of explosive
necessary for cutting steel sections. The following formula is used to determine the required charge size
(Table 3-3 is based on this formula) (see sample calculations in Appendix F, Figures F-3 and F-4, pages
F-3 and F-4):
3
P =( ) A or P = 0.375A
8
where—
P = TNT required (in pounds)
A = cross-sectional area of the steel member (in square inches) cross-sectional area for a circular
target (A = π r2 [π = 3.14])
Average Pounds of Explosive (TNT) for Rectangular Steel Sections of Given Dimensions
Thickness
of Section Height of Section (in)
(in)
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 16 18 20 22 24
1/4 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.5 1.7 1.9 2.1 2.3
3/8 0.3 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.9 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.6 1.7 2.0 2.3 2.6 2.8 3.1 3.4
1/2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.5 1.7 1.9 2.1 2.3 2.7 3.0 3.4 3.8 4.2 4.5
5/8 0.5 0.7 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.7 1.9 2.2 2.4 2.7 2.9 3.3 3.8 4.3 4.7 5.2 5.7
3/4 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.4 1.7 2.0 2.3 2.6 2.8 3.1 3.4 4.0 4.5 5.1 5.7 6.3 6.8
7/8 0.7 1.0 1.4 1.7 2.0 2.4 2.7 3.0 3.3 3.7 4.0 4.6 5.3 6.0 6.6 7.3 7.9
1 0.8 1.2 1.5 1.9 2.3 2.7 3.0 3.4 3.8 4.2 4.5 5.3 6.0 6.8 7.5 8.3 9.0
1/4 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.2 1.3 1.5 1.6 1.8
3/8 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.9 1.1 1.3 1.5 1.8 2.0 2.1 2.4 2.6
1/2 0.3 0.5 0.6 0.8 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8 2.1 2.3 2.6 2.9 3.2 3.4
5/8 0.4 0.6 0.8 0.9 1.1 1.5 1.8 2.2 2.5 2.9 3.2 3.5 3.9 4.3
3/4 0.5 0.7 0.9 1.1 1.3 1.8 2.1 2.6 3.0 3.4 3.8 4.3 4.7 5.1
7/8 0.6 0.8 1.1 1.3 1.5 2.1 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 5.9
1 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8 2.3 2.9 3.4 4.0 4.5 5.1 5.6 6.2 6.8
Note. Round up to the nearest 1/10 pound when calculating charge size.
Note. Experience has shown that a link filled with explosive will be severed by detonation. See
Appendix G for the underwater method.
Railroad Rails
3-32. The height of the railroad rail is the critical dimension for determining the amount of explosives
required. For rails 5 inches or more in height, such as rail crossovers or switches, 1 pound of explosives
should be used. For rails less than 5 inches high, use 1/2 pound of explosives (Figure 3-10, page 3-14).
Railroad frogs require 2 pounds of explosives. If possible, charges should be placed at vulnerable points,
such as frogs, switches, and crossovers. Charges should be placed at alternate rail splices for a distance of
500 feet and on the inside of the rails.
PURPOSE
3-33. When time and circumstances permit, special cutting charges (ribbon, saddle, and diamond charges)
should be used instead of conventional cutting charges. These charges may require extra time to prepare,
since they require exact and careful target measurement to achieve optimal effect. With practice, an
engineer can become proficient at calculating, preparing, and placing these charges in less time than
required for traditional charges. Special cutting charges use considerably less explosive than conventional
charges. Plastic-explosive (M112) or sheet explosive (M186) charges should be used as special charges.
Composition C4 requires considerable cutting, shaping, and molding that may reduce its density and,
therefore, its effectiveness. Using special cutting charges requires considerable training and practice.
RIBBON CHARGE
3-34. Ribbon charges are used to cut flat, steel targets up to 3 inches thick (Figure 3-11). The charge
thickness is made one-half the target thickness, but never less than 1/2 inch. The charge width is made three
times the charge thickness and the length of the charge is equal to the length of the desired cut. Ribbon
charges are detonated from the center of the C-shaped charge and the center of the top and bottom flange
charges when placing on I beams or wide-flange beams. When using the ribbon charge to cut structural
steel sections, the charge should be placed as shown in Figure 3-12. The detonating cord branchlines must
be the same length and must connect in a British junction (Figure 2-33, page 2-29). Figure F-5, page F-5,
shows how to calculate steel-cutting charges for steel plates. The charge thickness, width, and length is
determined as follows:
コ Charge thickness. The charge thickness equals one-half the thickness of the target; however, it
will never be less than 1/2 inch. The thickest part of the target is used to calculate the charge
thickness.
コ Charge width. The charge width equals three times the charge thickness.
コ Charge length. The charge length equals the length of the desired cut.
SADDLE CHARGE
3-35. This steel cutting method uses the destructive effect of the cross fracture formed in the steel by the
base of the saddle charge (the end opposite the point of initiation). This charge is used on mild steel bars,
whether round, square, or rectangular shaped, up to 8 inches in diameter (Figure 3-13, page 3-16). The
charge is made 1 inch thick. The dimensions, detonation, and the placement of the saddle charge is
determined as follows (see Figure F-7, page F-7, for an example calculation on steel cutting charges for
steel bars):
コ Dimensions.
ト Thickness. The charge should be made 1 inch thick (the standard thickness of M112 block
explosive).
ト Base width. The base width should be made equal to one-half the target circumference or
perimeter.
ト Long-axis length. The long-axis length should be made equal to the target circumference
or perimeter.
ト Volume (cubic inches). The volume is computed as: Long axis x base x 0.5 = volume.
コ Detonation. Detonate the saddle charge by placing a blasting cap or detonating cord knot at the
apex of the long axis.
コ Placement. Ensure that the long axis of the saddle charge is parallel with the long axis of the
target. Cut the charge to the correct shape and dimensions, and then place it around the target.
Ensure that the charge maintains close contact with the target by taping the charge to the target.
DIAMOND CHARGE
3-36. This stress-wave method employs the destructive effect of two colliding shock waves. The
simultaneous detonation of the charge from opposite ends (Figure 3-14) produces the shock waves. The
diamond charge is used on high-carbon or alloy steel bars that are up to 8 inches in diameter. The
dimensions, placement, and priming are determined as follows (for an example calculation on steel-cutting
charges for high-carbon steel, see Figure F-8, page F-7:
コ Dimensions.
ト Thickness. The charge should be made 1 inch thick (the standard thickness of an M112
block explosive).
ト Long-axis length. The long-axis length should be made equal to the target circumference.
ト Short-axis length. The short-axis length should be made equal to one-half the long axis.
ト Volume (cubic inches). The volume is computed as: Long axis x short axis x 0.5 = volume.
コ Placement. Place the explosive completely around the target so that the ends of the long axes
touch. Slightly increase the charge dimensions to do this, if necessary. Tape the charge to the
target to ensure adequate contact with the target.
コ Priming. Prime the diamond charge (Figure 3-14) with two detonating cord branchlines using
one of the following methods:
ト Detonating cord knots (Figure 2-15, page 2-15).
ト Two caps.
Note. When using a British junction, ensure that the branchlines are the same length.
CRITICAL FACTORS
3-37. Breaching charges are used to destroy bridge piers, bridge abutments, and permanent field
fortifications. The size, shape, placement, and tamping or confinement of breaching charges is critical to
success. The size and confinement of the explosive are the most critical factors, because the targets are
usually very strong and bulky. The intent of breaching charges is to produce and transmit enough energy to
the target to make a crater and create spalling. Breaching charges placed against reinforced concrete will
not cut metal reinforcing bars. After the concrete is breached, remove or cut the reinforcement with a steel-
cutting charge.
COMPUTATION
3-38. When performing a computation for breaching charges, the formula to determine the size of the
charge must be known. The breaching radius, the material factor, and the tamping factor must also be
known.
FORMULA
3-39. The following formula is used to determine the size of the charge required to breach concrete,
masonry, rock, or similar material:
P = R3KC
where—
P = TNT required (in pounds)
R = breaching radius( in feet)
K = material factor, which reflects the strength, hardness, and mass of the material to be demolished
(Table 3-5, page 3-18)
C = tamping factor, which depends on the location and tamping of the charge (Figure 3-15, page
3-18).
Material R K
BREACHING RADIUS
3-40. The breaching radius for external charges is equal to the thickness of the target being breached. For
internal charges placed in the center of the target mass, the breaching radius is one-half the thickness of the
target. If the charge is placed at less than one-half the mass thickness, the breaching radius is the longer of
the distances from the center of the charge to the outside surfaces of the target. For example, when
breaching a 4-foot wall with an internal charge placed 1 foot into the wall, the breaching radius is 3 feet
(the longest distance from the center of the explosive to an outside target surface). If placed at the center of
the wall mass, the breaching radius of the explosive is 2 feet (one-half the thickness of the target). The
breaching radius is 4 feet for an external charge on this wall. Values of R are rounded to the next higher
1/4-foot distance for internal charges and to the next higher 1/2-foot distance for external charges.
MATERIAL FACTOR
3-41. The material factor represents the strength and hardness of the target material. Table 3-5 gives values
for K for various types and thicknesses of material. When the target material cannot be positively
identified, assume that the target consists of the strongest material type in the general group. Always
assume that concrete is reinforced and masonry is first-class unless the exact condition and construction of
the target materials is known.
TAMPING FACTOR
3-42. The tamping factor depends on the charge location and the tamping materials used. Figure 3-15
shows the methods for placing charges and gives the values of C for both tamped and untamped charges.
When selecting a value for C from Figure 3-15, do not consider a charge tamped with a solid material (such
as sand or earth) as fully tamped unless the charge is covered to a depth equal to or greater than the
breaching radius. The water depth must be greater than the radius to use 1 as C.
Note. See Figure F-9, page F-8, for an example calculation on breaching charges for a
reinforced-concrete pier.
MATERIALS BREACHING
3-44. Table 3-6 can be used to determine the amount of composition C4 required for other materials by
multiplying the value from the table by the proper conversion factor from Table 3-7, page 3-21. The
following procedure can be used:
コ Determine the material type in the target. Assume that the material is the strongest type from the
same category if in doubt.
コ Determine from Table 3-6 the amount of explosive required if the object is made of reinforced
concrete.
コ Find the appropriate conversion factor from Table 3-7.
コ Multiply the number of packages of explosive required (Table 3-6) by the conversion factor
(Table 3-7).
Placement Methods
Reinforced
Concrete
Packages of M112 (Composition C4)
Thickness
(ft)
2.0 1 5 5 9 10 10 17
2.5 2 9 9 17 18 18 33
3.0 2 13 13 24 26 26 47
3.5 4 21 21 37 41 41 74
4.0 5 31 31 56 62 62 111
4.5 7 44 44 79 88 88 157
5.0 9 48 48 85 95 95 170
Note. The results of all calculations for this table have been rounded up to the next whole package.
Table 3-7. Conversion Factors for Material Other Than Reinforced Concrete
Earth 0.1
Ordinary masonry
Hardpan
Shale
Ordinary concrete 0.5
Rock
Good timber
Earth construction
Dense concrete
0.7
First-class masonry
NUMBER OF CHARGES
3-46. The following formula is used for determining the number of charges required for demolishing piers,
slabs, or walls:
W
N=
2R
where—
N = number of charges (If N is less than 1.25, use one charge; if N is 1.25 but less than 2.5, use two
charges; if N is equal to or greater than 2.5, round to the nearest whole number and use that many
charges.)
W = pier, slab, or wall width (in feet)
R = breaching radius (in feet)
PLACEMENT OF CHARGE
3-47. Before a charge is placed, the limitations and configuration of the charge must be known. The
paragraphs below describe the limitations and configuration of the charge placement.
Limitations
3-48. Piers and walls offer limited locations for placing explosives. Unless a demolition chamber (space
intentionally provided in a structure for the emplacement of explosive charges) (JP 1-02) is available, place
the charges against one face of the target. Placing a charge aboveground level is more effective than
placing one directly on the ground. When the demolition requires several charges to destroy a pier, slab, or
wall and elevated charges are to be used, the charges should be distributed equally no less than one
breaching radius high from the base of the target. This takes maximum advantage of the shock wave. If
possible, place breaching charges so that there is a free reflection surface on the opposite side of the target.
This free reflection surface allows spalling to occur. If time permits, tamp all charges thoroughly with soil
or filled sandbags. The tamped area must be equal to or greater than the breaching radius. For piers, slabs,
or walls partially submerged in water, charges should be placed at a distance equal to the breaching radius
and below the waterline (Figure 3-15, page 3-18).
Configuration
3-49. For maximum effectiveness, place the explosive charge in the shape of a flat square. The thickness of
the charge depends on the amount of explosive required (Table 3-1, page 3-3).
Placement
3-50. The first charge is placed R distance in from one side of the target. The remaining charges are spaced
at a distance of 2R apart, center to center (Figure 3-16).
COUNTERFORCE CHARGES
3-51. This special breaching technique is effective against rectangular masonry or concrete columns 4 feet
thick or less. It is not effective against walls, piers, or long obstacles. The obstacle must have at least three
free faces or be freestanding. If constructed of plastic explosives (composition C4), properly placed and
detonated, counterforce charges produce excellent results with a relatively small amount of explosive. Their
effectiveness results from the simultaneous detonation of two charges placed directly opposite each other
and as near the center of the target as possible (Figure 3-17).
CALCULATION
3-52. The thickness or diameter of the target determines the amount of plastic explosive required. The
amount of plastic explosive equals 1 1/2 times the thickness of the target in feet (1 1/2 pounds of explosive
per foot). Round fractional measurements to the next higher half foot before multiplying. For example, a
concrete target measuring 3 feet 9 inches thick requires 6 pounds of plastic explosive (1 1/2 pounds per foot
times 4 feet). For an example calculation on counterforce charges, see Figure F-10, page F-8.
PLACEMENT
3-53. When placing a counterforce charge, split the charge in half. The two halves are placed directly
opposite each other on the target. This method requires accessibility to both sides of the target so that the
charges will fit flush against their respective target sides.
PRIMING
3-54. On the face farthest from the target, prime a counterforce charge. The ends of the detonating cord
branchlines are joined in a British junction (Figure 3-17, page 3-23). The length of the branchlines must be
equal to ensure simultaneous detonation.
FACTORS
3-55. To be effective obstacles, craters must be too wide for track vehicles to span and too deep and steep-
sided for any vehicle to pass through. Blasted craters will not stop modern tanks indefinitely. A tank,
making repeated attempts to traverse a crater, will pull soil loose from the slopes of the crater, filling the
bottom, and reducing both the depth and slope angle of the crater.
SIZES
3-56. Craters are effective antitank (AT) obstacles if a tank requires four or more passes to traverse the
crater, thereby providing enough time for AT weapons to stop the tank. Craters should be large enough to
tie into natural or constructed obstacles at each end. The effectiveness of blasted craters can be improved
by placing log hurdles on either side, digging the face of the hurdle vertically on the friendly side, mining
the site with AT and antipersonnel (AP) mines, filling the crater with water, or using other means to further
delay enemy armor. Craters should be cut across the desired gap at a 45° angle from the direction of
approach. To obtain this 45° angle, the following formula should be used:
width x 1.414 = length of crater
3-57. To achieve enough obstacle depth, place craters in multiple rows. To enhance some other obstacle,
such as a bridge demolition, single or multiple rows should be used. When creating more than one row of
craters, they should be spaced far enough apart so that a single armored-vehicle-launched bridge (AVLB)
will not span them.
EXPLOSIVES
3-58. All military explosives can create AT craters. When available, use a 40-pound, composition H6,
cratering charge (Figure 1-4, page 1-8) for blasting craters.
CHARGE CONFINEMENT
3-59. Cratering charges or explosives should be placed in boreholes. Then, tamp them.
Shaped charges do not always produce open boreholes capable of accepting a 7-inch diameter cratering
charge. To accommodate the cratering charge, some earth may need to be removed or narrow areas
widened. Widen deep, narrow boreholes by knocking material from the constricted areas with a pole or rod
or by breaking off the shattered concrete on the surface with a pick or crowbar and posthole diggers.
BOREHOLES
3-62. All boreholes are to be dug the same depth (5 feet or deeper is recommended). The boreholes are
spaced at 5-foot intervals, center to center, across the area to be cratered. The following formula is used in
the six-step, problem-solving format (Section I), to compute the number of boreholes:
L - 16
N= +1
5
where—
N = number of boreholes (Round fractional numbers to the next higher, whole number.)
L = length of the crater (in feet) (Measure across the area to be cut. Round fractional measurements to
the next higher foot.)
16 = combined blowout of 8 feet on each side
5 = 5-foot spacing
1 = factor to convert from spaces to holes
CHARGE SIZE
3-63. Boreholes are loaded with 10 pounds of explosive per foot of borehole depth. When using standard
cratering charges, supplement each charge with additional explosives to obtain the required amount. For
example, a 6-foot hole would require one 40-pound cratering charge and 20 pounds of TNT or 16 packages
of composition C4.
FIRING SYSTEM
3-64. Dual-firing systems should be used (Figure 2-26, page 2-25). They are initiated with an M12, M13,
or M14. The 40-pound cratering charge is dual-primed as shown in Figure 2-21, page 2-20.
BOREHOLE TAMPING
3-65. All boreholes should be tamped with suitable materials.
Note. For an example calculation on cratering charges, see Figure F-11, page F-9.
from the surface to the crater bottom. However, the exact shape of the crater depends on the soil type. The
following procedures are used to create a relieved-face crater:
コ Drill two lines of boreholes 8 feet apart, spacing them at 7-foot centers on dirt- or gravel-
surfaced roads. Drill the two lines of boreholes 12 feet apart on hard-surfaced roads. Use the
following formula to compute the number of boreholes for the friendly-side row:
L - 10
N= +1
7
where—
N = number of boreholes (Round fractional numbers to the next higher, whole number.)
L = crater length (in feet) (Measure across the area to be cut. Round fractional
measurements to the next higher foot.)
10 = combined blowout of 5 feet on each side
7 = spacing of holes
1 = factor to convert spaces to holes
コ Stagger the boreholes in the row on the enemy side in relation to the holes in the row on the
friendly side (Figure 3-20).
Note. The line closest to the enemy will always contain one less borehole than the friendly line.
コ Make the boreholes on the friendly side 5 feet deep, and load them with 40 pounds of explosive.
Make the boreholes on the enemy side 4 feet deep, and load them with 30 pounds of explosive.
コ Use a dual-firing system for each line of boreholes. Prime 40-pound cratering charges as shown
in Figure 2-21, page 2-20.
コ Tamp all holes with suitable material.
3-68. There must be a 0.5- to 1.5-second delay in detonation between the two rows of boreholes. An M15
may be used as the delay detonation system. On the enemy side first, detonate the row. Then fire the
friendly-side row while the earth from the enemy-side detonation is still in the air.
MISFIRE PREVENTION
3-69. The shock and blast of the first row of charges may affect the delayed detonation of the friendly-side
charges. To aid in preventing misfires of the friendly-side charges, protect the detonating cord lines by
covering them with about 6 inches of earth.
BLASTING IN PERMAFROST
3-71. In permafrost, blasting requires about twice as many boreholes and larger charges than for cratering
operations in moderate climates. Blasted frozen soil breaks into clods 12 to 18 inches thick and 6 to
8 inches in diameter. Because normal charges have insufficient force to blow these clods clear of the
boreholes, the spall falls back into the crater when the blast subsides.
Boreholes
3-72. Before conducting extensive blasting, the soil should be tested in the area to determine the number of
boreholes needed. Boreholes are dug with standard drilling equipment, steam-point drilling equipment, or
shaped charges. Standard drilling equipment has one serious defect—the air holes in the drill bit freezes.
There is no known method to prevent this freezing. Steam-point drilling is effective for drilling boreholes
in sand, silt, or clay but not in gravel. Immediately after withdrawing the steam point, the charges should be
placed. If you do not, the area around the borehole thaws and collapses. Shaped charges are also effective
for producing boreholes, especially when forming craters. Table 1-3, pages 1-11 and 1-12, lists borehole
sizes made by shaped charges in permafrost and ice.
Explosives
3-73. If available, low-velocity explosives should be used for blasting holes in arctic climates. The
displacing quality of low-velocity explosives will more effectively clear large boulders from the crater. If
only high-velocity explosives are available, tamp the charges with water and let them freeze before
detonating. Unless thoroughly tamped, high-velocity explosives tend to blow out of the boreholes.
BLASTING IN ICE
3-74. Access holes in ice are required for obtaining water and determining the capacity of the ice for
bearing aircraft and vehicles and integrating obstacles. To accommodate rapid forward movements, ice
capacities must be determined quickly. Blasting operations provide this ability.
Boreholes
3-75. Small-diameter access holes should be made using shaped charges. An M2A4 charge will penetrate
ice as thick as 7 feet, an M3A1 charge will penetrate over 12 feet of ice (Table 1-3), and an M3A1 can
penetrate deeper. This has only been tested on ice that is about 12 feet thick. If placed at the normal
standoff distance, the charges form a large crater at the surface and require considerable probing to find an
actual borehole. A standoff distance of 42 inches or more should be used with an M2A4 shaped charge to
avoid excessive crater formation. An M2A4 creates a borehole with an average diameter of 3 1/2 inches.
An M3A1 borehole has an average diameter of 6 inches. In late winter, ice grows weaker and changes color
from blue to white. Although the structure and strength of ice vary, the crater effect is similar, regardless of
the standoff distance.
Craters
3-76. Surface craters are made with composition H6 cratering charges. For the best results, the charges
should be placed on the surface of cleared ice and tamp them with snow. When determining charge size,
keep in mind that ice has a tendency to shatter more readily than soil, and this tendency will decrease the
size of the charge.
DITCHING METHODS
3-80. Explosives can create ditches rapidly. Ditches are sloped at a rate of 2 to 4 feet of depth per 100 feet
of run. Ditches are placed in areas where natural erosion will aid in producing the correct grade. If a ditch
cannot be placed in an area aided by erosion, the ditch should be made deeper, increasing the depth as the
length increases. The single-line and cross-section methods are used for creating ditches.
SINGLE-LINE METHOD
3-81. The single-line method (Figure 3-21) is the most common ditching method. A single row of charges
are detonated along the centerline of the proposed ditch, leaving any further widening for subsequent lines
of charges. Table 3-8 gives charge configurations for the single-line method.
Borehole Borehole
Required Ditch Required Width Top of Charges per
Serial Depth (h) Spacing (s)
Depth (d) Ditch (w) (in ft) Hole (in lb)
(in ft) (in ft)
CROSS-SECTION METHOD
3-82. When the full width of the ditch in one operation must be blasted, the cross-section method should be
used (Figure 3-22). Table 3-9, page 3-30, gives charge configurations for the cross-section method. An
extra charge is placed midway between the lines of charges.
STUMP REMOVAL
3-83. Stumps have two general root types—taproot and lateral root (Figure 3-23). The stump diameter is
measured 12- to 18-inches aboveground level. Then the diameter is rounded to the next higher 1/2 foot.
One pound of explosive is used per foot of diameter for dead stumps and 2 pounds of explosive per foot of
diameter for live stumps. If the complete tree is being removed, 3 pounds of explosives per foot of diameter
should be used. If the root type cannot be identified, it is assumed that the tree has a lateral-root structure
and removal proceeds accordingly.
TAPROOTED STUMPS
3-84. Two methods are common for removing taprooted stumps. One method is to drill a hole in the
taproot and place the charge in the hole. Another method is to place charges on both sides of the taproot,
creating a shearing effect (Figure 3-23). If possible, the charges should be placed in contact with the root
and at a depth about equal to the diameter of the stump.
LATERAL-ROOTED STUMPS
3-85. When blasting lateral-rooted stumps, drill sloping holes between the roots (Figure 3-23). At a depth
equal to the radius of the stump base, drill the holes Place the charges as close to the center of the stump as
possible. Trees with large lateral roots may require additional charges. Additional charges are placed
directly underneath the large lateral roots.
BOULDER REMOVAL
3-86. Blasting is an effective way to remove boulders. The most practical methods are snake hole, mudcap,
and blockhole.
MUDCAP METHOD
3-88. With the mudcap method, the charge is placed in a crack or seam in the boulder (Figure 3-24, page
3-31). Then the charge is covered with 10 to 12 inches of mud or clay. Table 3-10 lists the required charge
sizes.
BLOCKHOLE METHOD
3-89. The blockhole method involves drilling a hole in the top of the boulder deep enough and wide
enough to hold the amount of explosive required (Table 3-10). The charge is primed with detonating cord
and is tamped firmly (Figure 3-24).
QUARRYING
3-91. Military quarries are generally open-faced and mined by the single- or multiple-bench method.
FM 3-34.465 gives detailed information on military quarries.
SURVIVABILITY POSITIONS
3-92. In many circumstances, using explosives can reduce digging time and effort. Explosives should only
be used in soil that would be excavated by a pick and shovel. Explosives are not recommended for
excavations less than 2 feet deep. To limit the dispersion of soil to as small an area as possible, use small
charges buried and spaced just enough to loosen the soil. Attempting to form a crater spreads soil over a
large area, affecting concealment and weakening the sides of the finished position. Explosives can create
individual-fighting positions and larger crew-served gun or vehicle positions. Explosives used in this
manner require some advance preparation. In the case of an individual-fighting position, the preparation
time may exceed the time required to prepare the position by traditional methods.
DEPTH
3-93. Charges are placed 1 foot shallower than the required depth to a maximum of 4 feet. If the required
depth is greater than 5 feet, dig the position in two stages, dividing the required depth in half for each stage.
Boreholes are made with an earth auger, wrecking bar, picket driver, or other expedient device.
SPACING
3-94. For rectangular excavations, the boreholes are dug in staggered lines. For circular excavations, the
boreholes are dug in staggered, concentric rings. The spacing (denoted as s) (Figure 3-25) between
boreholes in each line or ring and between lines or rings should be between 1 and 1 1/2 times the depth of
the borehole. All charges should be at least 2 feet inside the proposed perimeter of the excavation. Also, an
8- by 8-inch channel should be dug around the outer perimeter of the proposed excavation with the outer
edge of the channel forming the outer edge of the finished excavation. Figure 3-25 shows layouts for
rectangular and circular excavations.
CHARGE SIZE
3-95. To dig foxholes, use 1/4-pound charges of plastic explosive. For large excavations, use charges
between 1/2 and 1 1/2 pounds, depending on spacing and soil characteristics. A test shot is usually
necessary to determine the correct charge size.
CONCEALMENT
3-96. Reduce explosion noise and spoil scatter by leaving any sod in place and covering the site with a
blasting mat. Blasting mats can be improvised by tying tires together with natural or synthetic rope (steel
wire rope is unacceptable) or by using a heavy tarpaulin.
EQUIPMENT DESTRUCTION
3-97. The following paragraphs discuss how to destroy equipment, such as guns and vehicles.
DANGER
Steel-cutting charges produce metal fragments. Proper
precautions should be taken to protect personnel. Failure to
comply may cause death or permanent injury.
WARNING
Beware of potential radiological hazards associated with
ordnance (depleted uranium [DU] and some weapon system
sights [foreign-tritium]). Take proper protective measures before
and after equipment destruction. Failure to comply could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
GUNS
3-98. Gun barrels are destroyed with explosives or their own ammunition. Small components should be
removed or destroyed (such as sights and other mechanisms). The following procedures should be
performed when preparing a gun for demolition:
コ Block the barrel just above the breach. Solidly tamp the first meter of the bore with earth for
small-caliber guns that use combined projectile-propellant munitions. Load a projectile and aim
the tube to minimize damage if the round is ejected. For heavier guns that use projectiles,
separate from the propellants.
コ Refer to Table 3-11 for the charge size required for standard barrel sizes. Determine the required
charge size using the following formula (if necessary):
D2
P=
636
where—
コ Pack the explosive, preferably composition C4, into the breach immediately behind the tamping.
Place the plastic explosive in close contact with the chamber. Close the breach block as far as
possible, leaving only enough space for the detonating cord to pass without being bent or
broken. Place 15-pound charges on the drive wheels of tracked guns and on the wheels and axles
of towed guns, if time permits. Connect the branchlines in a junction box, or use a ring main.
Simultaneously detonate all charges.
1 76 10
2 105 18
3 120 23
4 155 38
5 203 66
Note. Determine the appropriate charge sizes for barrel sizes not listed by comparing them to
known barrel sizes. For example, use the explosive weight in Serial 3 for a 112-millimeter
barrel (23 pounds) and Serial 4 for a 152-millimeter barrel (38 pounds).
VEHICLES
3-99. To destroy friendly vehicles, refer to the applicable TM. When destroying vehicle components, use
the following priorities:
コ Priority 1. Carburetor, distributor, fuel pump or injectors, and fuel tanks and lines.
コ Priority 2. Engine block and cooling system.
コ Priority 3. Tires, tracks, and suspension system.
コ Priority 4. Mechanical or hydraulic systems (where applicable).
コ Priority 5. Differential and transfer case.
コ Priority 6. Frame.
Wheeled Vehicles
3-101. When using the explosive method, wheeled vehicles can be destroyed beyond repair by wrecking
the vital parts with a sledgehammer or explosives. If HEs are available, 2-pound charges should be used to
destroy the cylinder head, axles, and frame.
3-102. When using the improvised method, the engine oil and coolant should be drained and the engine
ran at full throttle until it seizes. To finish the destruction, burn the vehicle (ignite the fuel in the tank).
UNDERWATER DEMOLITIONS
3-103. See Appendix G for use and placement of underwater demolitions. Appendix G outlines the
techniques, tactics, and procedures for underwater clearance.
BRIDGE DEBRIS
4-1. Debris may cause enemy forces serious delays, if it obstructs the gap (Figure 4-1). Debris also
provides excellent concealment for mines and booby traps. Whenever possible, demolish bridges in such a
way that the resulting debris hinders reconstruction.
BRIDGE CATEGORIES
4-2. The first step in any efficient bridge demolition is to categorize the bridge correctly. The term
categorization has been adopted to avoid confusion with classification, which is concerned with the load-
carrying capacity of bridges. The correct categorization of bridges, coupled with an elementary knowledge
of bridge design, allows you to select a suitable attack method. All bridges fit into one of the following
three categories: simply supported, miscellaneous, and continuous.
SIMPLY SUPPORTED
4-3. In simply supported bridges, the ends of each span rest on the supports, and there are no intermediate
supports. The free bearing conditions shown in Figure 4-2 represent any bearing that allows some
horizontal movement (for example, roller bearings, sliding bearings, and rubber bearing pads).
MISCELLANEOUS
4-4. Miscellaneous bridges form a small portion of bridge structures. The theoretical principles governing
these bridges determine the appropriate attack methods. Examples of bridges in this category are
suspension, lift, and cable-stayed bridges.
CONTINUOUS
4-5. If a continuous bridge does not fit the miscellaneous category and is not simply supported, categorize
it as a continuous bridge. Hence, continuous has a wider meaning than multispan, or continuous-beam
bridges, as is normally implied.
ATTACK TYPES
4-6. When designing a bridge demolition, the first priority is to create a gap. This may require one or two
attacks to accomplish. Further actions to improve the obstacle may follow if the situation permits.
BOTTOM ATTACK
4-7. In a bottom attack, a hinge forms at the top. As the span falls, the cut ends at the bottom move
outward. The span may form a three-pin arch and fail to fall completely if the distance the cut ends must
move is greater than the total end clearance (denoted as E) between the span ends and the pier or abutment
faces (Figure 4-3). If a three-pin arch situation is likely, do not attempt a bottom attack.
TOP ATTACK
4-8. In a top attack, a hinge forms at the bottom. As the span falls, the cut ends at the top move inward.
Some bridges may jam along the faces of the cut before the ends of the span fall off the abutments, forming
a cranked beam (Figure 4-4). The length of span (denoted as LC) removed at the top should be enough to
prevent the formation of a cranked beam.
bridges may require two-stage attacks. Attacking the friendly side of spans will permit
economical reconstruction of the bridge at a later date, if necessary.
ト Priority 2. Improvements to the gap should be made. This activity is performed only when
it is specified on the demolition reconnaissance report. When no reconnaissance report has
been issued and time permits, perform improvements in the sequence specified below.
Deviation from this sequence should only be made under exceptional circumstances or
when directed to do so by the responsible commander. The standard sequence of demolition
is to destroy and mine the blown abutment, to lay mines in likely bypasses, to blast craters
and lay mines in likely approaches, and to destroy the piers.
CONCRETE-STRIPPING CHARGES
4-12. Concrete-stripping charges are bulk, surface-placed charges designed for removing concrete from
reinforced-concrete beams or slabs and exposing the steel reinforcement. Although these charges cause
some damage to the reinforcing steel, the extent of this damage cannot be predicted. These charges are
effective against reinforced-concrete beams or slabs up to 2 meters thick.
Charge Effects
4-13. Figure 4-10 shows the effect of the concrete-stripping charge. Using the proper charge size for the
thickness of the target will—
コ Remove all concrete from above the main reinforcing steel.
コ Remove all concrete from below the main reinforcing steel (spalling).
コ Damage the main reinforcing steel to some extent.
コ Destroy the minor reinforcing steel near the surface under the charge.
Charge Calculations
4-14. For all simply supported concrete bridges, removing all concrete over the required length of the span
removed will cause collapse. For beam or slab bridge spans (T beam and I beam bridges), determine the
charge sizes for the beams or slabs separately. The following procedure is used for determining charge
sizes for simply supported spans (see Figure F-12, page F-10, for an example calculation):
コ Calculate the mass of the charge required.
P = (3.3h + 0.5)3 (3.3)
where—
コ Calculate the width of the required ditch. (The charge will produce a ditch across the width of
the bridge.) Determine the width of this ditch using the following formula:
Wd = 2h + 0.3
where—
コ Compare the required Wd with the required LC, and take the appropriate action.
ト If LC is equal to or less than Wd, use one row of charges as specified by P.
ト If LC is greater than Wd but less than twice Wd, increase the size of the charge by
10 percent.
ト If LC is twice the Wd, double the charge and place them in two lines side by side.
コ Place charges in a continuous line across the full width of the bridge at the point of attack.
Ensure that the shape of the end cross section of the charge is such that the width is between one
and three times the height of the charge.
コ Tamp the charges, if required.
Note. No tamping is required for the concrete-stripping charge as calculated. If tamping with two
filled sandbags per pound of explosive, the calculated mass of charge should be reduced by one
third.
Steel-Beam Bridges
4-20. Steel-beam bridges may be constructed of normal steel-beam, plate-girder, or box-girder spans.
Figure 4-15 shows typical cross sections of these spans. For an example calculation, see Figure F-13,
page F-11.
Steel-Truss Bridges
4-21. Figure 4-16 shows the side elevations for three normal steel-truss spans. Note that all truss bridges
have diagonal members in the trusses.
Bowstring Bridges
4-23. Figure 4-18 shows the features of a normal bowstring bridge. The features of this bridge include the
following:
コ The bow is in compression.
コ The bow may be a steel beam, box girder, concrete beam, or steel truss. The depth (thickness) of
the bow is larger than or equal to the depth of the support members of the deck.
コ The deck acts as a tie and resists the outward force applied by the bow.
コ The deck is designed as a weak beam supported by the hangers.
Reconnaissance
4-25. For simply supported bridges, use the following reconnaissance procedures:
コ Categorize the bridge.
コ Measure the bridge using the following measurements with Figure 4-20 as an example:
ト Length (L). Measure the length of the span to be attacked in meters.
Note. This distance is not the clear gap, but the length of the longitudinal members that support
the deck from end to end.
ト Depth (H). Measure the depth of the beam, truss, or bow in meters (include the deck with
the beam or truss measurement).
ト Total end clearance (E). Total the amount of end clearance at both ends of the span in
meters.
ト Average length of the bearing supports (LS). Measure the average length of the bearing
supports from the ends of the spans to the faces of the abutments or piers in meters.
コ Determine the attack method (see Appendix H).
コ Determine the critical dimensions of the span required for charge calculations.
Attack Considerations
4-26. Two considerations apply when attacking a simply supported span. They are the point of attack and
the line of attack.
Point of Attack
4-27. Simply supported bridges should be attacked at or near the midspan. This is done because—
コ Bending movements are maximum at the midspan.
コ The likelihood of jamming during collapse is reduced if the bridge is attacked at the midspan.
Line of Attack
4-28. The line of attack should be parallel to the lines of the abutments (Figure 4-21). This reduces the risk
that the two parts of the span will slew in opposite directions and jam. Do not employ any technique that
induces a twist in the bridge. If the line of attack involves cutting across transverse beams, reposition the
line of attack to cut between the transverse beams.
Attack Methods
4-29. See Appendix H, Table H-4, pages H-4 through H-8. Table H-4 lists in recommended order, by
bridge category, the attack methods likely to produce the most economical demolition. Within each
category are variations to accommodate the differences in construction materials, span configurations, load
capacities (road, rail, or both), and gap and abutment conditions. The three recommended ways of attacking
simply supported spans are bottom, top, and angled attacks. In all cases, ensure that jamming cannot occur
during collapse. Use Table H-4 to determine the charge location.
attack or destroy one abutment at the places where jamming would occur. Figure F-13, page F-11, explains
the method for bottom attack calculations.
CONTINUOUS BRIDGES
4-33. Figure 4-23, page 4-16, is a categorization chart for continuous bridges. This chart is used like the
chart for simply supported bridges. There are six main subcategories: cantilever, cantilever and suspended
span, beam or truss, portal, arch, and masonry arch. The first five categories differentiate between steel and
concrete construction, because each material has a different attack method. If a continuous bridge is of
composite construction (for example, steel beams supporting a reinforced-concrete deck), the material that
comprises the main, longitudinal, load-bearing members will determine the attack method.
Cantilever Bridges
4-34. A cantilever bridge (Figure 4-24) has a midspan shear joint. The full lengths of the anchor spans may
be built into the abutments, making the cantilever difficult to identify.
Portal Bridges
4-37. For portal bridges (Figure 4-29), differentiate between those with fixed footings and those with
pinned footings because this affects the attack method. If the footing type cannot be determined, assume
that it has fixed footings. Portal bridges, as opposed to arch bridges, lack a smooth curve between the
bearing point of the span and the span itself.
Arch Bridges
4-38. In arch bridges (Figure 4-30), determine whether the bridge has an open or solid spandrel and fixed
or pinned footings. Again, when in doubt, assume that it has fixed footings.
Masonry-Arch Bridges
4-39. Masonry-arch bridges (Figure 4-31) should be identified by their segmental arch ring. It is easy to
mistake a reinforced-concrete bridge for a masonry arch bridge because many reinforced-concrete bridges
have masonry faces. The underside of the arch should always be checked. The underside is rarely faced on
reinforced-concrete bridges.
Reconnaissance
4-40. Reconnaissance for continuous bridges is discussed below. The following reconnaissance procedure
is used:
コ Categorize the bridge.
コ Measure the bridge using the following measurements, with Figure 4-32 as an example:
ト Length (L). Measure the span that is planned for attack (in meters) (between the centerlines
of the bearings).
ト Rise (H). For arch and portal bridges, measure the rise (in meters) (from the springing or
bottom of the support leg to the deck or top of the arch, whichever is greater).
コ Determine the attack method from Appendix H.
コ Determine the critical dimensions necessary for charge calculations.
Bridge Attacks
4-41. As with simply supported spans, two considerations apply when attacking continuous spans: the
point of attack and the line of attack. No common point-of-attack rule exists for all categories of continuous
bridges, but the line-of-attack rule applies to all continuous bridges. That is, the line of attack must be
parallel to the lines of the abutments, and twisting must not occur during the demolition. If the
recommended line of attack involves cutting across transverse beams, the line to cut between adjacent
transverse beams should be repositioned. Table H-5, pages H-9 through H-15, lists attack methods for
continuous spans.
Steel Bridges
4-42. When attacking continuous-span steel bridges, the seesaw or unsupported-member collapse
mechanism should be used. Both mechanisms produce complete cuts through the span. If charges can be
properly placed, these bridges might be demolished with a single-stage attack. However, on particularly
deep superstructures (concrete decks on steel beams), charges designed to sever the deck may not cut
through all of the reinforcing steel. Therefore, during reconnaissance, the possibility of a two-stage attack
on deep, composite superstructures should allows be planned for. Angle cuts should be made at about 70°
to the horizontal to prevent jamming during collapse.
Concrete Bridges
4-43. Continuous concrete bridges are the most difficult to demolish and are poor choices for reserved
demolitions. Even when construction drawings are available and there is ample time for preparation, single-
stage attacks are rarely successful.
MISCELLANEOUS BRIDGES
4-45. There are two types of miscellaneous bridges. They are suspension span bridges and moveable
bridges. The characteristics of these bridges are described in the paragraphs below.
Components
4-47. The components of suspension span bridges are cables, towers, trusses or girders, and anchors.
Suspension bridge cables are usually multiwire-steel members that pass over the tower tops and terminate
at anchors on each bank. The cables are the load-carrying members. (The Golden Gate Bridge has
127,000 miles of wire cable of this type.) The towers support the cables. Towers may be steel, concrete,
masonry, or a combination of these materials. The trusses or girders do not support the load directly; they
only provide stiffening. Anchors hold the ends of the cables in place and may be as large as 10,000 cubic
feet.
Demolishing Methods
4-48. The following paragraphs describe how to destroy major and minor bridges:
コ Major bridges. Anchors for major suspension bridges are usually too massive to be demolished.
The cables are usually too thick to be cut effectively with explosives. The most economical
demolition method is to drop the approach span or a roadway section by cutting the suspenders
of the main or load-bearing cables. The repair and tactical bridging capabilities of the enemy
determine the length of the target section. When reinforced-concrete towers are present, it may
be feasible to breach the concrete and cut the steel of the towers.
コ Minor bridges. The two vulnerable points on minor suspension bridges are towers and cables.
The following destruction methods are used:
ト Towers. Destroy towers by placing tower charges slightly above the level of the roadway.
Cut a section out of each side of each tower. Place the charges so that they force the ends of
the cut sections to move in opposite directions, twisting the tower.
Note. This prevents the end of a single cut from remaining intact. Demolition chambers in some
of the newer bridges make blasting easier, quicker, and more effective.
ト Cables. Destroy cables by placing charges as close as possible to anchor points, such as the
top of the towers. (Cables are difficult to cut because of the airspace between the individual
wires in the cable.) Ensure that the charge extends no more than one-half the circumference
of the cable.
Note. These charges are usually bulky, exposed, and difficult to place. Shaped charges are very
effective for cutting cable.
MOVABLE BRIDGES
4-49. Movable bridges have one or more spans that open to provide increased clearance for waterway
traffic. The three basic types of movable bridges are swing span, bascule, and vertical lift. The
characteristics of these bridges are described in the paragraphs below.
Bascule Bridges
4-52. Bascule bridges are more commonly known as drawbridges. These bridges usually have two leaves
that fold upward (Figure 4-35), but some bascule bridges may have only one leaf (Figure 4-36). The
movable leaves in bascule bridges appear in following three general forms:
コ Counterweights below the road level (most modern).
コ Counterweights above the road level (older type).
コ No counterweights (the oldest type, usually timber, lifted by cable or rope).
4-53. To destroy this bridge, demolish the cantilever arms with an attack method appropriate for simply
supported bridges. For partial demolition, the bridge and jam should be opened or the lifting mechanism
destroyed.
Floating Bridges
4-56. Floating bridges consist of a continuous metal or wood roadway. These bridges are supported by
floats or pontoons (Figure 4-38, page 4-24).
Pneumatic Floats
4-57. Pneumatic floats are airtight compartments of rubberized fabric inflated with air. For a hasty attack
of these bridges, the anchor cables and the bridle lines are cut with axes and the steel cables with
explosives. Also, the floats are punctured with small arms or machine-gun fire. Using weapons to destroy
the floats requires a considerable volume of fire because each float has a large number of watertight
compartments. Another method is to make a clean cut through the float, using detonating cord stretched
snugly across the surface of the pontoon compartments. One strand of cord is enough to cut most fabrics,
but two strands may be necessary for heavier materials. Also, one turn of a branchline cord is placed
around each inflation valve. This prevents the raft from being reinflated if it is repaired. Do not use
mainline cords to cut valves because the blast wave may fail to continue past any sharp turn in the cord.
Rigid Pontoons
4-58. Rigid pontoons are made of wood, plastic, or metal. To destroy these bridges, a 1/2-pound charge is
placed on the upstream end of each pontoon at water level. A charges are detonated simultaneously. If the
current is rapid, the anchor cables are cut so that the bridge will be carried downstream. Another method is
to cut the bridge into rafts. One-half pound charges are placed at each end of each pontoon, and detonate
them simultaneously. To destroy metal tread ways on floating bridges, the steel-cutting formula is used (see
Chapter 3). The placement and size of the charges depend on the bridge type. Placing cutting charges at
every other joint in the tread way will damage the bridge beyond use.
Bailey Bridges
4-59. To destroy Bailey bridges, 1-pound charges are placed between the channels of the upper and lower
chords. One-half pound charges for cutting diagonals and 1-pound charges are used for cutting sway
bracing (Figure 4-39).
In-Place Demolitions
4-60. The bridge should be cut in several sections by attacking the panels on each side, including the sway
bracing. The attack angle should be 10° to the horizontal to prevent jamming. In double-story or triple-story
bridges, increase the charges on the chords at the story-junction line. For further destruction, charges are
placed on the transoms and stringers.
ABUTMENTS
4-62. To demolish abutments, charges are placed in the fill behind the abutment. This method uses less
explosive than external breaching charges and also conceals the charges from the enemy. The disadvantage
is the difficulty in placing the charges. When speed is required, do not place charges behind abutments if it
is known that the fill contains large rocks.
WING WALLS
4-66. If the wing walls can support a rebuilt or temporary bridge, destroy the wing walls by placing
charges behind them the same as for abutments. See Figure 4-40 and Figure 4-41.
INTERMEDIATE SUPPORTS
4-67. Intermediate supports include external and internal charges. Each of these are discussed in the
paragraphs below.
EXTERNAL CHARGES
4-68. External charges are placed at the base of the pier or higher and are spaced by more than twice the
breaching radius (Figure 4-42, page 4-28). Charges are staggered to leave a jagged surface to hinder future
use. All external charges are thoroughly tamped with earth and sandbags if time, size, shape, and location
of the target permits.
INTERNAL CHARGES
4-69. Internal charges on intermediate supports require less explosive than external charges. (For charge
placement, see Figure 4-42.) However, unless the support has built-in demolition chambers, this method
requires an excessive amount of equipment and preparation time. The equation in paragraph 3-39 should be
used to determine the amount of each charge. M112 (composition C4) is ideal for internal charges. All
charges of this type should be thoroughly tamped with nonsparking tools (such as blunt, wooden tamping
sticks or similar tools). If the support has demolition chambers, the charges are placed in boreholes created
with shaped charges or drilled with pneumatic or hand tools. A 2-inch-diameter borehole holds about 2
pounds of explosive per foot of depth. The steel reinforcing bars, however, make drilling in heavily
reinforced concrete impractical.
Chapter 5
Demolition Operations and Training
Planning for demolitions and preliminary and reserved demolitions are described in
this chapter, including Orders for Demolition which is outlined in STANAG 2077.
The chapter also provides information on how to prepare DA Form 2203 (Demolition
Reconnaissance Record) and how to complete an obstacle folder as outlined in
STANAG 2123. This chapter also provides details for each simulated demolition
type, the priming methods for each type, the initiating set preparation, and the setup
of firing systems.
DEMOLITION OBSTACLES
5-2. A demolition obstacle is an obstacle created by using explosives. Although engineers use
explosives for quarrying, land-clearing, and other projects, their most important use is creating demolition
obstacles. Engineers use demolition obstacles in conjunction with many other types of obstacles, including
mines. They also use explosives to destroy materiel and facilities that must be abandoned (denial
operations).
DEMOLITION PLANNING
5-4. A demolition plan is the documentation with data required for the preparation of a single
demolition. Any demolition project is based on careful planning and reconnaissance. The following factors
are used as a basis for selecting and planning demolition projects:
コ The mission.
コ The limitations and instructions from a higher authority.
コ The current tactical and strategic situation and future plans (conditions that indicate the length of
time the enemy must be delayed, the time available for demolition, and the extent of denial
objectives).
コ The capabilities and limitations of the enemy, as well as the effect that denial operations have on
enemy forces, strategically and tactically.
コ The likelihood that friendly forces may reoccupy the area, requiring obstacle neutralization.
コ The economy of effort.
コ The time, material, labor, and equipment available.
コ The effect on the local population.
コ The target protection required.
DEMOLITION ORDERS
5-5. Authorized commanders use orders for the demolition to pass their orders to the demolition guard (a
local force positioned to ensure that a target is not captured by an enemy before orders are given for its
demolition and before the demolition has been successfully fired [the definition was shortened, and the
complete definition is printed in the glossary]) (FM 1-02) (JP 1-02) and the demolition firing party (the
party at the site that is technically responsible for the demolition and that actually initiates detonation or
fires the demolitions) (FM 1-02) (JP 1-02). The orders for the demolition, as outlined in STANAG 2017
and QSTAG 508, is a standard four-page form used by the North Atlantic Treaty Organization (NATO) and
ABCA countries. This form is used for preparing all reserved and preliminary demolitions. Page one of the
form contains the instructions, duties, and responsibilities of demolition personnel.
PRELIMINARY DEMOLITIONS
5-6. With prior authority, a preliminary demolition is detonated immediately after preparation.
Preliminary demolitions present fewer difficulties to both commanders and engineers than do reserved
demolitions. Commanders may restrict preliminary demolitions for tactical, political, or geographical
reasons.
ADVANTAGES
5-7. Preliminary demolitions have some advantages. They are as follows:
コ Engineers normally complete each task and move to the next without having to leave demolition
guards or firing parties at the site.
コ Preparation efforts are less subject to interference by enemy or friendly troops.
コ Elaborate precautions against failure are not required; preliminary demolitions require only
single-firing systems.
コ Engineers can perform demolition operations for a particular target in stages rather than all at
once.
PROGRESSIVE PREPARATION
5-8. When preparation time is limited, engineers prepare the demolition in progressive stages. This gives
the engineers the ability to create effective obstacles even if preparations must stop at any stage.
RESERVED DEMOLITIONS
5-9. The responsible commander must carefully control a reserved demolition target. The target may be a
vital part of the tactical or strategic plan or the demolition will be performed in close contact with the
enemy.
CONSIDERATIONS
5-10. Occasionally, errors in orders, control, or timing cause serious consequences during demolition
operations. In addition, engineers may encounter the following special problems when dealing with
reserved demolition targets:
コ Traffic lanes must be kept open until the last moment. This means they cannot use the simplest
and quickest demolition techniques to accomplish the mission.
コ Demolitions must be weatherproofed and protected from traffic vibrations and enemy fire over
long periods. Dual-firing systems must be used and demolitions must be carefully placed and
protected from passing vehicles or pedestrians.
コ Demolition sites must be guarded until the demolitions are fired.
RESPONSIBILITIES
5-13. The paragraphs below describe the responsibilities of authorized commanders, demolition guard
commanders, and demolition-firing party commanders.
Authorized Commanders
5-14. These commanders have overall responsibility for the operational plan. At any stage of the operation,
they may delegate responsibilities. For example, when authorized commanders withdraw through other
units’ intermediate positions, they pass control to the commanders holding the intermediate positions. The
commanders holding the intermediate positions then become the authorized commanders. Authorized
commanders—
コ Designate demolition targets as reserved targets.
コ Order the demolition guard, and detail the strength and composition of the guard party.
コ Specify the state of readiness and order changes to the state of readiness, if necessary.
コ Give the orders to fire demolitions.
コ Give the demolition guard commander or the demolition-firing party commander the authority,
in case of imminent capture, to fire the demolition on his own initiative.
コ Destroy captured or abandoned explosives and demolition materials to prevent them from falling
into enemy hands.
Note. Commanders should carefully select the demolition site and consider all safety precautions
necessary when destroying abandoned demolitions. Chapter 6, Section IV, covers the procedures
and methods for destroying explosives.
コ Issue written instructions (demolition orders) to the unit providing the demolition guard and
demolition-firing party.
コ Notify all headquarters of any delegation of authority or reclassification of any demolition from
a reserved to a preliminary status.
コ Establish effective channels for communicating firing orders and readiness states to demolition
guard commanders or demolition-firing party commanders.
Command Post
5-18. The demolition guard commander should place his command post where he can best control the
defense of the demolition target from the friendly side. However, this location may conflict with the
requirements of the demolition firing point, which should be close to or collocated with the command post.
Usually, some compromise is necessary.
Firing Point
5-19. The firing point should be as close to the target as safety allows. The firing point must protect the
firing party from the effects of blast and falling debris and be positioned so that the demolition-firing party
commander is—
Alternate Positions
5-20. The demolition guard commander should designate an alternate command post and firing point, if
possible. The firing party should be able to fire the demolitions from either the primary or alternate firing
points.
Checkpoint
5-21. When units are withdrawing from an enemy advance, identification can be a problem. Withdrawing
troops are responsible for identifying themselves to the demolition guard. The demolition guard must
always establish and operate a checkpoint. The demolition guard commander may use military police to
perform this duty. Good communication is essential between the checkpoint and the demolition guard
commander. Each unit withdrawing through the demolition target should send a liaison officer to the
checkpoint, well in advance of the arrival of the withdrawing unit.
Refugee-Control Points
5-22. The demolition guard commander may need to establish and operate a refugee-control point for
civilian traffic. He should place a checkpoint on the enemy bank and a release point on the friendly bank to
control refugees. The commander may use military or local police to operate the control points. Personnel
operating the checkpoints should halt refugees off the route and then escort them, in groups, across the
target to the release point. Refugees must not interfere with the movement of withdrawing forces or
demolition preparations.
RECONNAISSANCE ORDERS
5-23. Thorough reconnaissance is necessary before planning a demolition operation. Reconnaissance
provides detailed information in all areas related to the project. Before conducting any reconnaissance, the
reconnaissance party commander must receive clear objectives. The reconnaissance order specifies these
objectives. This information helps the reconnaissance party to determine the best method of destroying the
target and to estimate the preparation time required. For example, if the reconnaissance party knows that
manpower and time are limited but explosives are plentiful, they may design demolitions requiring few
men and little time but large quantities of explosives. These orders should detail the reconnaissance party to
determine the following:
コ The location and nature of the target.
コ The purpose of the demolition operation (to delay an enemy infantry battalion for 3 hours).
コ The proposed classification of the demolition (reserved or preliminary).
コ The firing system type desired (dual or single).
コ The economy of effort (whether the demolition must be completed in one stage or multiple
stages).
コ The utility of the target during demolition operations (whether the target must remain open to
traffic during demolition preparations).
コ The amount of time allowed or expected between preparation and execution of the demolition
operation.
コ The amount of time allowed for changing the state of readiness (safe to armed).
コ The labor and equipment available for preparing the demolitions.
コ The types and quantities of explosives available.
RECONNAISSANCE RECORD
5-24. A reconnaissance party reports the results of its reconnaissance on DA Form 2203. The form is used
with the appropriate sketches to record and report the reconnaissance of military demolition projects.
Figure I-1, page I-4, contains a sample of DA Form 2203 and instructions to complete it. Available paper is
used and attached to the completed DA Form 2203.
5-25. When time and conditions permit, the reconnaissance report is used as the source document for
preparing the obstacle folder. If the obstacle folder is not available, this report is used in its place. In certain
instances, the report may require a security classification. For the required information and instructions, see
DA Form 2203.
OBSTACLE FOLDER
5-26. The obstacle folder, as outlined in STANAG 2123 and QSTAG 743, provides all the information
necessary to complete a specific demolition operation. NATO and ABCA personnel use this booklet to
collect information and to conduct demolition operations. The responsible commander should prepare an
obstacle folder during peacetime for all preplanned targets to allow for efficient demolition operations.
Obstacle folders are prepared for reserved and preliminary demolitions. The obstacle folder is not used in
tactical situations because the detailed information in the obstacle folder, including multiple languages, is
not easily completed under field or tactical conditions.
LANGUAGE
5-27. Since not all NATO and ABCA personnel speak the same language, obstacle folders must be
multilingual. The preparing unit may speak a different language than the unit actually conducting the
demolition operation. Therefore, it is essential to prepare the obstacle folder in more than one language.
However, prepare map notes, plans, sketches, and so forth in one language, and provide translations for the
other languages in the available space. The languages necessary in an obstacle folder is determined based
on the following:
コ The languages of the units involved in the demolitions.
コ The language of the host nation.
コ One of the two official NATO languages (English or French).
CONTENTS
5-28. The obstacle folder contains six sections for recording information. Additional information may be
noted in the appropriate place within the obstacle folder and then inserted as an additional page
immediately following the notation (for example, “location and type, see page 4a”). The following are the
six parts of the obstacle folder:
コ Location of the target.
コ Supply of explosives and equipment.
コ Orders for preparing and firing.
コ Handover and takeover instructions.
コ Demolition report.
コ Official signature.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS
5-29. The list of explosives, stores, and mines required does not cover every possible situation. However, it
does indicate a logical order for recording or determining the required materials. Only the materials
required for the particular target are marked. The transport team leader uses the first list. For major
operations, note the size, composition, and mission of the various participating work parties. The
demolition-firing party commander may detach the first copy of the demolition report and forward it to a
higher-echelon headquarters.
OVERVIEW
5-31. Currently, 10 DESs are available for field training exercises. These devices simulate the—
コ Sheet explosive.
コ M112 (composition C4) block.
コ 1-pound TNT block.
コ M5A1 demolition block.
コ M183 demolition (satchel) charge.
コ M2A3 15-pound shaped charge.
コ M3 40-pound shaped charge.
コ 40-pound cratering charge.
コ Bangalore torpedo.
コ M1 military dynamite.
5-32. DES devices can simulate blowing mines in place, destroying timber trestle bridges, destroying
captured equipment and supplies, cratering, and gaining access to a building during training for urban
operations. All of these missions can be executed safely with little or no damage to facility infrastructures.
5-33. All charges except the M112 (composition C4) block and the sheet explosive are chalk charges.
Chalk charges are various containers filled with a chalk powder, sand mixture, and detonating cord. The
detonating cord is the explosive propellant that discharges the chalk powder. The M112 DES block is a
nonexplosive clay compound that replicates composition C4. The sheet explosive is made of nonexplosive
rubber matting. The explosive signatures come strictly from the detonating cord blast.
PREREQUISITES
5-34. Soldiers who assemble DES devices must be familiar with all detonating cord priming methods (see
Chapter 2). The 8-wrap Uli knot is the primary priming method. It gives the DES the explosive power to
create the desired sound signatures and expel the chalk that creates the visual signature. Other priming
methods are the girth hitch with an extra turn, the triple-roll knot, the double-overhand knot, and the
common and alternate methods.
PRIMARY USES
5-37. This charge is primarily used for the following charges:
コ Ribbon.
コ Saddle.
コ Diamond.
コ Steel-cutting.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-38. The following steps should be used to assemble sheet explosive DESs:
コ Step 1. Cut out eight pieces of rubber matting (1/8 by 3 by 11 inches).
コ Step 2. Place two pieces of matting side by side.
コ Step 3. Put glue on the rough side of one sheet (Figure 5-1), leaving enough space for inserting
the MDI cap. Do not put glue where the MDI cap will be inserted for priming.
コ Step 4. Place the rough sides of the sheets together (Figure 5-1), and weight with a heavy object
until the glue dries.
コ Step 5. Ensure that the glue is completely dry, and package four 1/4-inch-thick sheets
(Figure 5-1) into a plastic bag.
コ Step 6. Seal the plastic bag with clear tape.
コ Step 7. Place a DES label on the package.
コ Step 8. Place 20 DES charges into each shipping container.
コ Step 9. Label each container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-39. The sheet explosive DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 2 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 12 by 3 by 1/4 inches.
コ Packaging: 20 per container.
コ Container: 13 3/8 by 15 1/2 by 7 5/8 inches.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-40. The bill of materials (BOM) for a sheet explosive is shown in Table 5-1.
Material Quantity
Glue 6 oz
Clear tape 2 ft
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-42. The M112 charge is used primarily for steel-cutting charges, forced entry of buildings, breaching,
cutting timber, demolishing bridges, and neutralizing mines.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-43. The following steps should be used to assemble M112 (composition C4) block DESs:
コ Step 1. Remove the moist pottery clay from the shipping container.
コ Step 2. Mold the clay into a 1 1/4-pound block. Use a mold to form the clay correctly (1 by 2 by
10 inches) (Figure 5-2, page 5-10).
コ Step 3. Cover the block with a thin covering of mineral oil.
コ Step 4. Place the block into a clear plastic bag, and seal the bag tightly with clear tape.
コ Step 5. Place two-sided adhesive tape on the backside of the packaged clay block.
コ Step 6. Label the front with a DES label.
コ Step 7. Box 30 DES blocks per shipping container.
コ Step 8. Label each container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-44. The M112 block DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 1 1/4 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 1 by 2 by 10 inches.
コ Packaging: 30 blocks per container.
コ Container: 13 3/8 by 15 1/2 by 7 5/8 inches.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-45. The BOM for an M112 (composition C4) block DES is shown in Table 5-2.
Material Quantity
Mineral oil 1 oz
Clear tape 10 in
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-47. This charge is used primarily for the following:
コ Neutralizing mines.
コ Reducing fortifications.
コ Urban operations.
コ Breaching.
コ Cutting timber.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-48. The following steps should be used to assemble 1-pound, TNT-block DESs:
コ Step 1. Assemble the box by folding along the creases (Figure 5-3).
コ Step 2. Tape the box to prevent it from unfolding.
コ Step 3. Fill half of the box with a 50:50 mixture of chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 4. Tie an Uli knot, and place it in the box.
コ Step 5. Finish filling the box with the chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 6. Make a small hole in the top flap.
コ Step 7. Thread the free end of the detonating cord through the hole at least 18 inches.
コ Step 8. Close the top flap, and completely tape the outside with olive drab fabric tape.
コ Step 9. Label each block with a DES label.
コ Step 10. Place 48 TNT DES devices in each shipping crate.
コ Step 11. Label each crate.
Note. Omit steps 3 and 5 if using detonating cord as an external primer or if priming with a
nonelectric or electric blasting cap inserted in a cap well.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-49. The 1-pound, TNT-block DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 1 pound.
コ Dimensions: 7 by 1 3/4 by 1 3/4 inches.
コ Packing: 48 blocks per box.
コ Packing Box: 7 5/8 by 16 1/2 by 12 3/8 inches.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-50. The BOM for a 1-pound, TNT-block DES is shown in Table 5-3, page 5-12.
Material Quantity
Cardboard box 1 ea
Detonating cord 4 ft
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-52. The M5A1 charge is used primarily for the following:
コ Demolishing bridges.
コ Breaching.
コ Neutralizing mines.
コ Reducing fortifications.
コ Cutting timber.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-53. The following steps should be used to assemble M5A1 demolition-block DESs:
コ Step 1. Assemble the box by folding along the creases (Figure 5-4).
コ Step 2. Tape the box to prevent it from folding.
コ Step 3. Fill half of the box with a 50:50 mixture of chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 4. Tie an Uli knot, and place it in the box.
コ Step 5. Finish filling the box with the chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 6. Make a small hole in the top flap.
コ Step 7. Thread the free end of the detonating cord through the hole at least 18 inches.
コ Step 8. Close the top flap, and completely tape the outside with olive drab fabric tape.
コ Step 9. Label each block with a DES label.
コ Step 10. Place 24 demolition blocks in each container.
コ Step 11. Label each container.
Note. Omit steps 4 and 5 if using detonating cord as an external primer or when priming with a
nonelectric or electric blasting cap inserted in a cap well.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-54. The M5A1 demolition-block DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 2 1/2 pounds.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-55. The BOM for an M5A1 demolition block DES is shown in Table 5-4.
Material Quantity
Cardboard box 1 ea
Detonating cord 4 ft
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-57. This charge is used primarily for—
コ Breaching.
コ Demolishing bridges.
コ Reducing fortifications.
コ Destroying cache sites.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-58. The following steps should be used to assemble M183 satchel-charge assembly DESs:
コ Step 1. Construct four M5A1 DES demolition blocks using the assembly instructions for the
M5A1 in paragraph 5-38, page 5-8, except for having an 8-inch tail of detonating cord coming
out the bottom. Ensure that only one of the blocks has the 18-inch length of cord extending out
of the top; trim all others evenly with the top of the box and tape shut.
コ Step 2. Tape the four M5A1 demolition blocks DES together.
コ Step 3. Cut and place 12 inches of detonating cord along the bottom end of the M5A1 blocks
(Figure 5-6).
コ Step 4. Tape or tie the 8-inch tails of the M5A1 blocks to the 12-inch detonating cord along the
bottom.
コ Step 5. Trim off and tape all detonating cord ends.
コ Step 6. Place the four demolition blocks in a sandbag that has been cut or rolled back, exposing
the top edge of the four blocks (Figure 5-6).
コ Step 7. Repeat steps 1 through 6 for the second half of the M183.
コ Step 8. Place the two complete sandbags into the canvas satchel charge bag, and tie it shut.
コ Step 9. Place a DES label on the satchel charge.
コ Step 10. Place two satchel charges in each shipping container.
コ Step 11. Label each container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-59. The M183 demolition-satchel charge DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 20 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 12 3/4 by 10 1/4 by 4 7/8 inches.
コ Packaging: Two satchel charges per container.
コ Container: 13 1/4 by 10 3/4 by 11 1/4 inches.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-60. The BOM for an M183 demolition-satchel charge DES is shown in Table 5-5.
Material Quantity
Detonating cord 4 ft
Fabric tape 48 in
Sandbag 2 ea
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-62. This charge is primarily used for the following:
コ Cratering.
コ Destroying abutments.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-63. The following steps should be used to assemble M2A3 15-pound, shaped charge DESs:
コ Step 1. Cut the cardboard tube insert (10 inches), and glue a plastic cap on one end (Figure 5-7).
Allow it to dry.
コ Step 2. Fill half of the tube with a 50:50 mixture of chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 3. Tie an Uli knot or double-overhand knot in 36 inches of detonating cord. Place the knot
inside the tube (Figure 5-7). Finish filling the tube with the chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 4. Cut a 1/8-inch hole in the center of a second plastic cap.
コ Step 5. Thread the detonating cord through the hole in the cap with a minimum of 18 inches
extending out.
コ Step 6. Glue the cap on the open end of the tube, and allow it to dry.
コ Step 7. Place tape over the free-running end of the detonating cord.
コ Step 8. Place the cardboard tube into the steel, shaped charge training device, threading the
detonating cord up through the fuse well at least 18 inches (Figure 5-7).
コ Step 9. Tape the end of the detonating cord to the charge.
コ Step 10. Label each charge with a DES label.
コ Step 11. Place three DES shaped charges into an old shipping container, or place four charges if
using a new container.
コ Step 12. Label the container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-64. The M2A3 15-pound, shaped charge DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 15 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 14 15/16 by 7 inches.
コ Packing: Old container, three charges; new container, four charges.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-65. The BOM for an M2A3 15-pound, shaped charges is shown in Table 5-6.
Material Quantity
Cardboard tube 1 ea
Detonating cord 4 ft
Plastic cap 2 ea
Glue 1 container
Fabric tape 4 ft or 2 ea
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-67. This charge is used primarily for the following:
コ Cratering.
コ Destroying abutments.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-68. The following steps should be used to assemble M3 40-pound, shaped charge DESs:
コ Step 1. Cut a cardboard tube insert (12 inches), and glue a plastic cap on one end (Figure 5-8,
page 5-18). Allow it to dry.
コ Step 2. Fill half of the tube with a 50:50 mixture of chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 3. Tie an Uli knot or a double-overhand knot in 36 inches of detonating cord, and place the
knot inside the tube.
コ Step 4. Finish filling the tube with the chalk powder and sand mixture (Figure 5-8).
コ Step 5. Cut a 1/8-inch hole in the center of a second plastic cap.
コ Step 6. Thread the detonating cord through the hole in the cap with a minimum of 18 inches
extending out.
コ Step 7. Glue the cap on, and allow it to dry.
コ Step 8. Place tape over the free-running end of the detonating cord.
コ Step 9. Place the cardboard tube into the steel, shaped charge training device, threading the
detonating cord up through the fuse well at least 18 inches (Figure 5-8).
コ Step 10. Tape the bottom end of the detonating cord to the charge.
コ Step 11. Label each charge with a DES label.
コ Step 12. Place one DES shaped charge in each shipping container.
コ Step 13. Label each container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-69. The M3 40-pound, shaped charge DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 40 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 15 7/16 by 10 7/8 inches.
コ Packing: One per container.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-70. The BOM for a M3 40-pound, shaped charge DES is shown in Table 5-7.
Material Quantity
Cardboard tube 1 ea
Detonating cord 4 ft
Glue 1 container
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-72. This charge is used primarily for the following:
コ Cratering.
コ Destroying abutments.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-73. The following steps should be used to assemble 40-pound, cratering charge DESs:
コ Step 1. Glue a plastic cap in the bottom of the cardboard tube, and allow it to dry.
コ Step 2. Cut a 1/8-inch hole about 8 inches from the top of the tube (Figure 5-9, page 5-20).
コ Step 3. Tie three Uli knots or a double-overhand knot about 10 inches apart in a length of
detonating cord, leaving about 18 inches after the last knot (Figure 5-9).
コ Step 4. Place the first knot along the bottom of the tube.
コ Step 5. Tape the remaining knots to the inside of the tube, ensuring that the detonating cord does
not cross over itself.
コ Step 6. Fill the tube halfway with the chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 7. Thread the running end of the detonating cord through the 1/8-inch hole (Figure 5-9).
Ensure that at least 18 inches of detonating cord extends out of the hole.
コ Step 8. Finish filling the tube with the chalk powder and sand mixture. Use a scale to ensure the
proper weight.
コ Step 9. Glue a plastic end cap in the top of the tube.
コ Step 10. Place a DES label on the tube.
コ Step 11. Place one DES 40-pound cratering charge in each shipping container.
コ Step 12. Label each container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-74. The 40-pound, cratering charge DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 40 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 24 by 7 inches.
コ Packing: One charge per box.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-75. The BOM for a 40 pound, cratering charge DES is shown in Table 5-8.
Material Quantity
Cardboard tube 1 ea
Detonating cord 8 ft
Plastic bag 1 ea
Glue 1 container
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-77. The bangalore torpedo DES is used primarily clearing the following:
コ Wire obstacles.
コ AP minefields.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-78. The following steps should be used to assemble bangalore torpedo DESs:
コ Step 1. Tie at least three Uli knots, equally spaced, in an 18-foot length of detonating cord
(Figure 5-10, page 5-22).
コ Step 2. Thread the detonating cord through the 5-foot cardboard tube, leaving equal amounts
extending out of each end.
コ Step 3. Take a 2-inch-long by 1-inch-diameter plastic plumber’s coupling, and drill two 1/8-inch
holes completely through the coupling at half an inch from each end.
コ Step 4. Thread the running end of the detonating cord through the two holes at the top. Wrap the
cord around the coupling five times, and tape it in place.
コ Step 5. Thread the detonating cord through one of the holes at the bottom of the coupling.
コ Step 6. Pass the detonating cord through both holes of the 3/4-inch plastic coupling, and tape it
down.
コ Step 7. Insert the 3/4-inch coupling into the 1-inch coupling (Figure 5-10).
コ Step 8. Insert the coupling assembly into the cardboard tube, keeping it flush with the end of the
tube.
コ Step 9. Wrap the assembly with fabric tape to keep a tight fit in the main tube.
コ Step 10. Cut an eyelet in the plastic end cap, and glue it into the end of the tube.
コ Step 11. Gently pull any of the slack out of the detonating cord through the opposite end of the
cardboard tube.
コ Step 12. Fill the tube with 15 pounds of 50:50 mixture of chalk powder and sand.
コ Step 13. Repeat steps 3 through 8 at the other end.
コ Step 14. Cut an eyelet in the plastic end cap, and glue it into the end of the tube.
コ Step 15. Label all DES tubes.
コ Step 16. Box 10 tubes per shipping container. Label each container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-79. The bangalore torpedo DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 15 pounds.
コ Dimensions: 5 feet by 2 1/8 inches in diameter.
コ Packing: 10 tubes per shipping container.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-80. See Table 5-9. The BOM for a bangalore torpedo DES is shown in Table 5-9.
Material Quantity
Detonating cord 18 ft
Glue 6 oz
Fabric tape 2 ft
DES label 1 ea
PRIMARY USES
5-82. The military dynamite DES is used primarily for the following:
コ Cratering.
コ Removing stumps.
コ Breaching.
ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
5-83. The following steps should be used to prime with an MDI:
コ Step 1. Glue an end cap into one end of the tube, and allow it to dry.
コ Step 2. Punch four 1/8-inch priming holes through both sides of the tube at designated locations
(Figure 5-11, page 5-24).
コ Step 3. Fill the tube up almost to the first hole with the chalk powder and sand mixture.
コ Step 4. Tamp a 1/2-inch piece of clay fill on top of the chalk powder and sand mixture past the
first hole.
コ Step 5. Fill the tube with the chalk powder and sand mixture almost up to the next hole.
コ Step 6. Tamp a 1/2-inch piece of pottery clay into the tube past the second hole.
コ Step 7. Repeat the process for the third and fourth holes.
コ Step 8. Glue the second end cap in place, and allow it dry.
コ Step 9. Tape the tube with olive drab fabric tape.
コ Step 10. Tape the holes with a 1/2-inch strip of red tape.
コ Step 11. Label with a DES label.
コ Step 12. Package 100 per shipping container.
SPECIFICATIONS
5-85. The M1 military dynamite DES specifications are as follows:
コ Weight: 1/2 pound.
コ Dimensions: 8 by 1 1/4 inches.
コ Packing: 100 per box.
BILL OF MATERIALS
5-86. The BOM for an M1 military dynamite DES is shown in Table 5-10.
Material Quantity
End cap 2 ea
Glue 3 oz
DES label 1 ea
Note. A 6-inch length of detonating cord equals the power output of a blasting cap. However,
detonating cord will not detonate explosives as reliably as a blasting cap because its power is not
as concentrated. Therefore, always use several turns or a knot of detonating cord for priming
charges.
Detonating Cord
5-90. Either an Uli knot, a double-overhand knot, or a triple-roll knot (Figure 5-12) and one of the
following methods is used to prime sheet explosives:
コ Method 1. Insert the knot between two sheets of explosive.
コ Method 2. Place the knot on top of the sheet explosive, and secure it with a small strip of sheet
explosive (Figure 5-13). Strengthen the primed area by wrapping it with green duct tape or
electrical tape.
Note. The M8 blasting-cap holder has three teeth that prevents the clip from withdrawing from
the explosive; two spring arms firmly hold the M11 cap in the M8 holder.
コ Method 2. Cut a notch in the sheet explosive DES (about 1 1/2 inches long and 1/4 inch wide).
Insert the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or M152 cap or booster to the limit of the
notch. Secure the blasting cap with a strip of sheet explosive and adhesive tape.
コ Method 3. Place 1 1/2 inches of the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or M152 cap or
booster on top of the sheet explosive DES. Secure it with a strip of sheet explosive DES (at least
3 by 3 inches) and adhesive tape.
コ Method 4. Insert the end of the blasting cap 1 1/2 inches between two sheets of DES sheet
explosive. Wrap the sheets with tape to secure the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or
M152 cap or booster.
Detonating Cord
5-93. To prime M112 (composition C4) block DES with detonating cord, use Figure 5-15 and the
following steps:
コ Step 1. Form either an Uli knot or a triple-roll knot (Figure 5-12, page 5-26).
コ Step 2. Cut a notch out of the DES large enough to insert the knot that was formed.
WARNING
Use a sharp, nonsparking knife on a nonsparking surface to cut
the explosive. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
Note. It is not recommended that an M112 (composition C4) block DES be primed by wrapping
it with detonating cord, since wraps will not properly detonate the actual explosive charge.
Detonating Cord
5-96. DES blocks without internal detonating cord boosters can be primed with detonating cord using
several methods (Figure 5-16, page 5-30). The two standard methods are the—
コ Common method (method 1). Lay one end (2-foot length) of detonating cord at an angle across
the DES block. Wrap the running end around the block three turns, laying the wraps over the
standing end. Slip the running end (on the forth wrap) under all wraps, parallel to the standing
end, and draw the wraps tight.
コ Alternate method (method 2). Place a loop of detonating cord on the DES block, leaving
enough length on the end to make four turns around the block and loop. Start the first wrap, and
ensure that you immediately cross over the standing end of the loop, working your way to the
closed end of the loop. Pass the free end of the detonating cord through the loop, and pull it tight
to form a knot around the outside of the block.
Figure 5-17. Priming a TNT Block DES (With Adapter) Using an MDI
Note. Prepare the initiating set before priming. Cap control must be according to the information
in this manual.
コ Step 2. Wrap a string tightly around the DES block and tie it securely, leaving about 6 inches of
loose string at each end.
コ Step 3. Insert the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or M152 cap or booster into the cap
well. Make a cap well if there is not one.
コ Step 4. Tie the loose string around the fuse to prevent the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23,
M151, or M152 cap or booster from separating from the block (Figure 5-18).
Note. Electrical or friction tape can also effectively secure an M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23,
M151, or M152 cap or booster in the DES.
Detonating Cord
5-99. See Figure 5-19. The following steps and Figure 5-19, page 5-32, are used to prime with detonating
cord:
コ Step 1. Use M2 crimpers to punch four holes through the DES dynamite cartridge in areas
covered by red tape. Ensure that the DES cartridge is rotated 180° after punching each hole to
keep the holes parallel.
コ Step 2. Lace the detonating cord through the holes in the same direction the holes were punched.
コ Step 3. Secure the detonating cord tail by passing it between the detonating cord lace and the
DES dynamite charge.
End-Priming Method
5-101. See Figure 5-20. The following steps and Figure 5-20 are used to perform end priming:
コ Step 1. Use M2 crimpers to make a cap well in the end of the dynamite cartridge.
コ Step 2. Insert the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or M152 cap or booster into the cap
well.
コ Step 3. Tie the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or M152 cap or booster and fuse
securely in the cartridge with a string.
Side-Priming Method
5-102. See Figure 5-21. The following steps and Figure 5-21 are used to perform side priming:
コ Step 1. Use M2 crimpers and make a cap well (about 1 1/2 inches long) in the side of the DES
cartridge at one end. Slightly slant the cap well so the M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151,
or M152 cap or booster, when inserted, will be nearly parallel to the side of the DES cartridge
and the explosive end of the cap will be at a point nearest the middle of the cartridge.
コ Step 2. Insert a M11, M14, M18, M19, M21, M23, M151, or M152 cap or booster into the cap
well.
コ Step 3. Tie a string securely around the fuse. Wrap the string tightly around the cartridge,
making two or three turns before tying it.
Note. Weatherproof the primed cartridge by wrapping a string closely around the cartridge,
extending it an inch or so on each side of the hole to cover the hole completely. Cover the string
with a weatherproof sealing compound.
Note. This device also has an internal propellant (detonating cord) to expel the chalk powder and
sand mixture.
5-104. The paragraphs below contain priming instructions for the following:
コ A 1-pound, TNT block DES.
コ An M5A1 demolition block DES.
コ An M183 demolition satchel charge DES.
コ An M2A3 15-pound, shaped charge DES.
コ An M3 40-pound, shaped charge DES.
コ A 40-pound, cratering-charge DES.
Detonating Cord
5-106. The method shown in Figure 5-22 is used for 1-pound TNT DES. Also, one of the three methods
for TNT without an internal detonating cord booster can be used, except the 18-inch tail is placed under the
wraps of the detonating cord.
Figure 5-22. Priming a TNT DES (With Booster) Using Detonating Cord
Detonating Cord
5-109. See Figure 5-24 for priming the block. This is the same as TNT priming (paragraphs 2-23 through
2-28).
Detonating Cord
5-112. See Figure 5-25, page 5-36. Figure 5-25 shows how to prime the M183 demolition (or satchel
charge) assembly with detonating cord.
Detonating Cord
5-115. See Figure 5-27. Figure 5-27 shows how to prime an M2A3 15-pound, shaped charge DES using
detonating cord.
Figure 5-27. Priming a 15-Pound, Shaped Charge DES Using Detonating Cord
Detonating Cord
5-118. See Figure 5-29. Figure 5-29 shows how to prime a 40-pound, shaped charge DES using
detonating cord.
Figure 5-29. Priming a 40-Pound, Shaped Charge DES Using Detonating Cord
Note. Do not use caps belowground. All belowground charges must be dual-primed with a
minimum of 1 pound of explosive.
Detonating Cord
5-121. See Figure 5-31. Figure 5-31 shows how to prime a 40-pound, cratering charge DES using
detonating cord.
Figure 5-31. Priming a 40-Pound, Cratering Charge DES Using Detonating Cord
Detonating Cord
5-124. A bangalore torpedo is primed using detonating cord as shown in Figure 5-33, page 5-40, or by
tying a square knot in place of the tape. When using a square knot, allow 6-inch tails to prevent misfires
from moisture contamination. Never use the short end (tail) of the detonating cord to initiate the torpedo.
Initiation must come from the running end of the detonating cord. Square knots may be placed in water or
in the ground, but the cord must be detonated from a dry end or aboveground.
SAFETY GUIDELINES
5-127. Unit leaders should continually make safety a primary emphasis during all phases of mission
planning and training whether inert, DES, or live explosives are in use. Leaders must continually review
safety references and teach safety procedures to each Soldier. Before using DESs, units must perform a risk
assessment. (See Appendix K for the safety risk assessment.)
LEADER RESPONSIBILITIES
5-128. Leaders must be aware of the need to address safety during all phases of an operation. Unit leaders
must constantly remind junior leaders and Soldiers about safety, and note deficiencies throughout the
planning, preparation, and execution phases of a demolition mission. Leaders need to consider the
following points during planning, preparation, and execution phases of all demolition operations:
コ Do not divide responsibilities for preparing, placing, or firing charges. Ensure that one individual
is responsible for supervising all phases of the operation.
コ Prime and use explosive materials according to their intended purpose.
コ Ensure that MSDs are enforced and tactically or administratively cleared.
Note. At a minimum, leaders and Soldiers must maintain the MSD as prescribed in AR 385-63
and Table 6-2, page 6-7, of this FM.
コ Ensure that Soldiers handle and inspect all DESs and live munitions according to this FM.
コ Ensure that transportation and storage are according to the local demolitions standing operating
procedure (SOP). Ensure that units establish appropriate ammunition handling areas.
コ Ensure that no blasting caps or firing systems are attached to any detonating cord or other charge
(DES or live) unless a demolitions NCO is notified he and approves of it.
CONSIDERATIONS
6-1. When dealing with demolitions, general safety should be observed. The following should be
considered when dealing with the general safety of demolitions:
コ Do not attempt to conduct a demolitions mission if you are unsure of the demolition procedures;
review references or obtain assistance.
コ Prevent inexperienced personnel from handling explosives.
コ Avoid dividing responsibility for demolition operations.
コ Use the minimum number of personnel necessary to accomplish the demolition mission.
コ Take your time when working with explosives; make your actions deliberate.
コ Post guards at all times to prevent access inside the danger radius.
コ Maintain control of the blasting machine or initiation source at all times.
コ Use the minimum amount of explosives necessary to accomplish the mission while keeping
enough explosives in reserve to handle any possible misfires.
コ Maintain accurate accountability of all explosives and accessories.
コ Store blasting caps separately and at a safe distance from other explosives.
コ Ensure that all personnel and equipment are accounted for before detonating a charge.
コ Ensure that warnings are given before initiating demolitions; give the warning “Fire in the hole!”
three times.
コ Guard the firing points at all times.
コ Assign a competent safety officer for every demolition mission.
コ Dual initiate all demolitions, regardless of whether they are single- or dual-primed.
コ Avoid using deteriorated or damaged explosives.
コ Do not dismantle or alter the contents of any explosive material.
コ Do not mix live and inert (dummy) explosives.
コ Do not use blasting caps underground. Use detonating cord or M151 or M152 boosters to prime
underground charges. See FM 3-34.465 for quarry operations.
EXPLOSIVE MATERIALS
6-2. Explosive materials consist of blasting caps, time fuse, shock tubes, detonating cord, low-strength
detonating cord, plastic and sheet explosives, FPE binary explosive charges, and commercial explosives.
Boosters consists of M151s and M152s (see Chapter 2). The paragraphs below describe how each of these
materials are used.
BLASTING CAPS
6-3. Both military and commercial blasting caps are extremely sensitive and can explode unless handled
carefully. Blasting caps can detonate if exposed to extreme heat (cook off). Military blasting caps are more
powerful and often more sensitive than their commercial counterparts. When using commercial blasting
caps to detonate military explosives, ensure that they are powerful enough to detonate the explosives, thus
avoiding misfires.
WARNING
Power requirements for electric caps from different
manufacturers vary, so never mix caps from different
manufacturers or lots because this could result in misfires.
Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury or
damage to equipment.
6-4. When installing caps in explosives, never force them into an explosive or a cap well; the appropriate
tool for making or enlarging the cap well should be used. When taping the blasting cap onto the detonating
cord, ensure that 1/8 to 1/4 inch of the cap is clearly visible at both ends. When nonessential personnel are
on site, do not connect blasting cap initiating sets to ring or line mains or charges. Blasting caps should
never be left unattended before or after attaching them to the charges or firing system.
コ Keep electric blasting caps at least 155 meters from energized power lines. Temporarily cut the
power to the lines during blasting operations if using electric blasting caps near power lines.
コ Use at least the minimum current required to fire electric blasting caps.
コ Check circuit continuity of electric blasting caps before use.
コ Cover connections between blasting cap leads and firing wires with insulating tape, not the
cardboard spool.
コ Remove firing wire loops and, if practical, bury blasting wires.
WARNING
Never mix caps from different manufacturers because power
requirements for electric caps from different manufacturers vary
and could result in misfires. Failure to comply could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
TIME FUSE
6-7. When using time fuse, the following procedures are used:
コ Conduct a test burn of at least 3 feet for each roll of time fuse. Perform another test burn before
using the fuse if the fuse has not been used within 24 hours of the test burn.
コ Use M2 crimpers to cut the time fuse. Use a sharp knife to cut the fuse if serviceable M2
crimpers are not available. Ensure that the fuse end is cut squarely. Make the cut on a
nonsparking surface, such as wood.
コ Avoid cutting the fuse until it is ready to be inserted into the igniter and blasting cap.
コ Do not use the first or last 6 inches of the time fuse from a new or partial roll (this helps to avoid
problems from moisture infiltration).
コ Avoid sharp bends, loops, and kinks in the time fuse.
コ Avoid stepping on the fuse.
Note. Any of these conditions or actions can break the powder train and result in a misfire.)
SHOCK TUBES
6-8. The detonation is contained within the plastic tubing and if strands of tubing touch or cross over each
other there is no concern that an inadvertent ignition would occur. Fragments from blasting caps or other
explosive charges travel at speeds three to five times faster than the detonating wave in the shock tube.
These fragments could cause damage to other shock tube assemblies. The following procedures are applied:
コ Never use crimpers when cutting shock tubes.
コ Splice shock tubes only when the MDI components cannot be replaced.
6-9. The flash of the shock tube can produce a burn if a piece of shock tube is held when it is functioning,
even through the olive drab coating. Therefore, never hold a shock tube while detonating an explosive
system. If an unsealed shock tube is left unused for extended periods, it may not be reliable and should not
be used.
DETONATING CORD
6-10. Detonating cord should not be carried or held around your neck. The additional 6-inch tail should not
be cut off when cutting detonating cord because 6-inch tails are standard on the knots to avoid moisture
infiltration. Sharp bends, loops, and kinks should be avoided, and the cord should not be stepped on. Any of
these conditions or actions can change the path of detonation or cause the cord to cut itself. When using
detonating cord, the following procedures are used:
コ Use M2 crimpers to cut the time fuse. Use a sharp knife to cut the fuse if serviceable M2
crimpers are not available. Ensure that the fuse end is cut squarely. Make the cut on a
nonsparking surface, such as wood.
コ Avoid cutting the fuse until it is ready to be inserted into the blasting cap.
コ Do not use the first or last 6 inches of the time fuse from a new or partial roll (this helps to avoid
problems from moisture infiltration).
Note. Any of these conditions or actions can change the path of detonation or cause the cord to
cut itself.
Note. Once the contents of the binary components are mixed, they form an explosive, and the
process cannot be undone.
コ Hold the liquid container with the seal facing up, and screw the powder container onto the liquid
container to avoid spilling the contents when screwing the two nonexplosive containers together.
コ Ensure that the binary charges are preprimed with a booster attached to low-strength detonating
cord.
コ Avoid sharp bends, loops, crossovers, and kinks in the branchlines.
コ Avoid stepping on the cord.
Note. Any of these conditions or actions can change the path of low-strength detonating cord or
cause the cord to cut itself.
コ Do not twist or pinch the cord when using the branchline to lower the explosive charges into
bore holes.
コ Do not use excessive force to pull out the charges if the charges need to be readjusted in the
borehole.
COMMERCIAL EXPLOSIVES
6-14. Commercial dynamite is sensitive to heat, shock, and friction and is not recommended for use in
combat areas. Old commercial dynamite should not be used, because it is extremely sensitive and very
unstable. The procedures in DA Pamphlet 385-64, the Army publications used, or the manufacturer’s
recommendations should be followed to destroy aged commercial dynamite. When commercial dynamite
freezes, it becomes covered with crystals and is very unstable (do not use frozen dynamite).
Note. Commercial dynamite containing nitroglycerin requires special handling and storage.
When in storage, commercial dynamite should be rotated to prevent the nitroglycerin from
settling to the bottom of the explosive.
BOREHOLES
6-15. No void spaces should be left in boreholes, especially in quarrying operations. A secondary
explosion can result from a borehole with voids between loaded explosives. After the first blast, it may take
up to 15 minutes for such an explosion to occur. All voids should be tamped with the appropriate material.
When using detonating cord wick to dig boreholes, allow at least 30 minutes for boreholes to cool between
placing and firing successive detonating cord wick, or cool the boreholes with water or compressed air to
save time.
TOXICITY
6-16. Enough time should be allowed for blast fumes, dust, and mist to clear before inspecting or
occupying a blasting area. Most military explosives are poisonous if ingested and will produce lethal gases
if detonated in confined areas (such as tunnels, caves, bunkers, and buildings). TNT is extremely poisonous
and it should be avoided when blasting in enclosed areas.
WARNING
When working with explosives, avoid touching sensitive areas of
your body, such as around the face and groin. After working with
explosives, wash your hands, especially before consuming food.
Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury or
damage to equipment.
LIGHTNING
6-18. Lightning is a hazard to both electric and nonelectric blasting charges. A lightning strike or a nearby
miss is almost certain to initiate either system type. If lightning strikes occur, even far away from the
blasting site, electrical firing circuits could be initiated by high, local earth currents and shock waves
resulting from the strikes. These effects are increased when lightning strikes occur near conducting
elements, such as fences, railroads, bridges, streams, and underground cables or conduits and in or near
buildings. The only safe procedure is to suspend all blasting activities during electrical storms or when an
electrical storm is imminent.
STATIC ELECTRICITY
6-19. Though rare, electric blasting caps can possibly be initiated by static electricity. If possible, avoid
using electric blasting caps if static electricity is a problem. Exercise extreme caution when working with
explosives in cold, dry climates or when wearing clothing and equipment that produce static electricity,
such as clothing made of nylon or wool. Before handling an electric blasting cap, always remove the static
electricity from your body by touching the earth or a grounded object. It may be necessary to perform this
grounding procedure often in an area where static electricity is a constant problem.
INDUCED CURRENTS
6-20. Radio signals can induce a current in electric blasting caps and prematurely detonate them. Table 6-1
lists the MSDs from transmitters for safe electrical blasting. This table applies to operating radio, radar,
microwave, cellular telephone, and television transmitting equipment near electric caps. Keep mobile
transmitters and portable transmitters at least 50 meters from any electric blasting cap or electrical firing
system. Electric blasting caps should not be used within 155 meters of energized power transmission lines.
0 to 29 30
30 to 49 50
50 to 99 110
100 to 249 160
250 to 499 230
500 to 999 305
1,000 to 2,999 480
3,000 to 4,999 610
5,000 to 19,999 915
20,000 to 49,999 1,530
50,000 to 100,000 3,050
*When the transmission is a pulsed- or continuous-wave type and its pulse widths are less than 10 microseconds, the
left-hand column indicates the average power. For all other transmitters, including those with pulse widths greater
than 10 microseconds, the left-hand column indicates peak power.
BLAST EFFECTS
6-21. A blast effect is the destruction of or damage to structures and personnel by the force of an explosion
on or above the surface of the ground. Blast effect may be contrasted with the cratering and ground-shock
effects of a projectile or charge that goes off beneath the surface. (JP 1-02) (FM 1-02)
6-22. Personnel close to explosions may experience permanent hearing loss or other injury from the
pressure wave caused by an explosion. Hearing protection should be worn during all blasting operations.
Personnel observing MSDs for bare charges (Table 6-2 and AR 385-63) generally will not be affected by
blast effects. See AR 385-63 and DA Pamphlet 385-63 for additional information on blast effects.
Table 6-2. MSD for Personnel in the Open (Near Bare Charges)
MISSILE HAZARDS
6-23. Explosives can propel lethal missiles great distances. The distances these missiles will travel in the
air depends primarily on the relationship between the missiles weight, shape, density, initial projection
angle, and initial speed. Under normal conditions, the missile-hazard area of steel-cutting charges is greater
than that of cratering, quarrying, and surface charges.
UNDERWATER OPERATIONS
6-24. Underwater operations include the use of explosives, nonelectric caps, time fuse, detonating cord,
MDI components, and M60 or M81 fuse igniters. Each of these is discussed in detail in the paragraphs that
follow.
EXPLOSIVES
6-25. Explosives are subject to erosion by water. Unprotected explosives will deteriorate rapidly, reducing
their effectiveness. All exposed explosives should be adequately protected when used in water, especially
running water.
NONELECTRIC CAPS
6-26. Nonelectric caps depend on combustion to work properly. Any moisture inside a nonelectric cap may
cause a misfire. Because nonelectric blasting caps are difficult to waterproof, explosives should be primed
with detonating cord. The M151 or M152 boosters and detonating cord can be used to prime demolition
charges underwater.
TIME FUSE
6-27. Time fuse depends on combustion to burn properly. Time fuse burns significantly faster underwater
due to water pressure. The fuse is placed underwater at the last possible moment before firing.
Note. If the mission requires using time fuse underwater, then do the testburn underwater.
DETONATING CORD
6-28. The ends of detonating cord are sealed with a waterproof sealing compound when using detonating
cord for initiating underwater charges or charges that will remain in place several hours before firing.
Leaving a 6-inch overhang in the detonating cord will protect the remaining line from moisture.
SAFE DISTANCES
6-31. The following general rules apply when determining the distances at which personnel in the open are
relatively safe from missiles created by bare charges placed on the ground, regardless of the type or
condition of the soil (AR 385-63). Table 6-2, page 6-7, lists the MSDs for selected charge weights.
コ Charges of less than 27 pounds. The minimum missile-hazard distance is 300 meters.
コ Charges of more than 27 pounds, but less than 425 pounds. The distances in Table 6-2
should be used.
コ Charges of more than 425 pounds. The MSD is 750 meters.
コ Charges of more than 2,000 pounds. The following formulas should be used:
6-32. Missile-proof shelters can be as close as 100 meters from the detonation site, provided they are
strong enough to withstand the heaviest possible missile resulting from the demolition. All personnel will
wear approved protective helmets and single hearing protection.
ト If a steel-cutting bunker is not available, charges will be fired in an excavated pit that is at
least 1 meter deep, and a mat made of a hemp-type material must cover the charge.
Steel-cutting charges fired outside a steel-cutting bunker will not exceed 0.9 kilogram.
ト Personnel must be a minimum of 100 meters from the charge at detonation and must be in a
missile proof shelter, 300 meters in defilade, or 1,000 meters if in the open.
コ Charges placed on concrete.
ト Charges placed on concrete will not exceed 18 kilograms and should be placed on the side
nearest the observers.
ト Observers must be at least 100 meters away in a missile-proof shelter, 300 meters away in
defilade, or 900 meters away in the open. An unoccupied distance of 900 meters will be
provided on the opposite side of the charge where most missile hazards will be thrown.
BANGALORE TORPEDO
6-34. Personnel must be a minimum of 100 meters from the charge at detonation. Personnel must be in a
missile-proof shelter, 300 meters if in a defilade, or 1,000 meters if in the open.
SLAM M4
6-35. Personnel must be a minimum of 100 meters from the charge at detonation. Personnel must be in a
missile-proof shelter, 300 meters if in a defilade, or 1,000 meters if in the open.
NONELECTRIC
6-36. Nonelectric misfires may be caused by—
コ Moisture in the time fuse, detonating cord, or explosives.
コ Failure to seat the time fuse completely in the blasting cap or the fuse igniter.
コ Failure to seat the shock tube or time fuse completely in the fuse igniter.
コ Breaks in the time fuse, shock tube, or detonating cord.
コ Time fuse having jagged or uneven ends.
コ Failure to seat the blasting caps securely in the cap well or explosive.
コ Loosely or improperly installed detonating cord.
コ Debris in the blasting cap.
コ Blasting caps from commercial sources that are not strong enough to detonate military
explosives.
PREVENTION
6-37. Nonelectric misfires are minimized by taking the following precautions:
コ Prepare and place all primers properly.
コ Load all charges carefully.
コ Detonate charges with the proper techniques.
コ Use dual-initiation systems and, if possible, dual-firing systems.
コ Use detonating cord or M151 or M152 for underground demolitions. Do not bury the blasting
caps.
コ Perform tamping operations carefully to avoid damaging prepared charges.
コ Avoid crimping blasting caps onto time fuse in the rain; seek a covered area out of the rain.
コ Ensure that the time fuse or shock tube is completely seated when installing it into a blasting cap
or fuse igniter.
CLEARING PROCEDURE
6-38. The Soldier who placed the charges should investigate any misfires, and correct any problems with
the demolition using the following procedures:
Note. During training, the range safety officer (RSO) or officer in charge (OIC) should
investigate any misfires and correct any problems with the demolitions.
コ After attempting to fire the demolition, delay investigating any detonation problem for at least
30 minutes, plus the time remaining on the secondary initiating system. Sometimes, tactical
conditions may require an investigation before the 30-minute limit.
Note. For Navy and Marine Corps, wait 60 minutes plus the time remaining on the secondary
initiating system (see NAVSEA SW060-AA-MMA-010).
コ For aboveground misfires of charges primed with blasting caps, place a primed, 1-pound charge
next to the misfired charge, and detonate the new charge. Each misfired charge or charge
separated from the firing circuit that contains a blasting cap requires a 1-pound charge for
detonation. Scattered charges that contain blasting caps should not be touched; they must be
destroyed in place. For charges primed with detonating cord, follow the procedures in
paragraphs 6-42 through 6-45.
コ For a nonelectric cap that has detonated but failed to initiate a detonating cord branchline, line
main, or ring main, attach a new cap to the detonating cord, and then move to a safe place.
コ For buried charges, remove the tamping to within 1 foot of the misfired charge and constantly
check the depth while digging to avoid striking the charge. When you are within 1 foot of the
misfired charge, place a primed, 2-pound charge on top of the original charge, and detonate the
new charge. If digging over the original charge is impractical, dig a new borehole of the same
depth beside the original hole, 1 foot away, and then place a primed, 2-pound charge in the new
hole and detonate the new charge.
ELECTRIC
6-39. Electric misfires may be caused by—
コ An inoperable or weak blasting machine or power source.
コ Improper operation of the blasting machine or power source.
コ Defective or damaged connections (such as short circuits, breaks in the circuit, or too much
resistance in the electrical wiring) are common conditions resulting in misfires.
コ Faulty blasting caps.
コ Different manufacturers’ blasting caps being used in the same circuit.
コ An inadequate power source for the number of blasting caps in the circuit (such as too many
caps or too small a blasting machine).
PREVENTION
6-40. One Soldier should be assigned the responsibility for all the electrical wiring in a demolition circuit.
This Soldier should—
コ Perform all splicing.
コ Install all blasting caps in the firing circuit, and not bury the blasting caps.
コ Make all of the connections between blasting cap wires, connecting wires, and firing wires.
コ Inspect the system for short circuits.
コ Avoid grounding out the system.
コ Ensure that the number of blasting caps in any circuit does not exceed the rated capacity of the
power source.
CLEARING PROCEDURE
6-41. The following procedures are used to clear electric misfires:
コ Make another attempt to fire.
コ Use the secondary firing system, when present.
コ Check the wire connections, blasting machine, or power-source terminals.
コ Disconnect the blasting machine or power source, and test the blasting circuit. Check the
continuity of the firing wire with a circuit tester.
コ Use another blasting machine or power source and attempt to fire the demolition again, or
change operators.
コ Disconnect the blasting machine, shunt the wires, and investigate immediately when employing
only one electrical-initiation system. When employing more than one electrical-initiation system,
wait 30 minutes before inspecting. (Tactical conditions may require an investigation before the
30-minute limit.)
Note. For Navy and Marine Corps, wait 60 minutes (see NAVSEA SW060-AA-MMA-010).
Note. When using a combination-initiated system, refer to paragraph 6-36 through 6-38for the
procedures for a nonelectric misfire.
DETONATING CORD
6-42. The paragraphs below should be used when dealing with detonating cord misfires. Discussed is how
to handled detonating cord, detonating cord priming, and M151 and M152 booster low-strength detonating
cord misfires.
DETONATING CORD
6-43. If the detonating cord fails to function properly, a new blasting cap should be attached to the
remaining detonating cord, taking care to fasten it properly, and detonate the new blasting cap. Branchlines
should be treated the same.
TRANSPORTATION
6-46. When transporting explosives, Soldiers should observe both military and commercial transportation
regulations and safety procedures. The paragraphs below discuss these regulations and procedures.
REGULATIONS
6-47. Both military and commercial carriers are subject to regulations when transporting military
explosives and other dangerous military materials within the United States. AR 385-64 and
DA Pamphlet 385-64 contain the minimum safety requirements for handling and transporting military
explosives and ammunition. When transporting explosives outside the United States, follow the regulations
from the host countries as well. All explosives transport personnel must learn the local procedures and
safety procedures.
SAFETY PROCEDURES
6-48. The commander should assign a primary and assistant operator to each vehicle transporting
explosives on public highways, roads, or streets. Whenever transporting explosives locally, operators must
observe safety rules.
Vehicles
6-49. When using vehicles to transport explosives, these precautions are followed:
コ Ensure that vehicles are in good condition. Inspect all vehicles intended for hauling explosives
before loading them. Protect against any short circuits in the electrical system.
コ Install fire-resistant and nonsparking cushioning to separate the explosives from any metal truck
components if using vehicles with steel or partial-steel bodies.
コ Do not load vehicles beyond their rated capacities when transporting explosives.
コ Cover open-bodied vehicles hauling explosives with a fire-resistant tarpaulin.
コ Mark all vehicles transporting explosives with reflective placards indicating the explosive types
carried (see AR 385-64 and DA Pamphlet 385-64).
コ Use demolition transports for explosives only. Do not carry metal tools, carbides, oils, matches,
firearms, electric storage batteries, flammable substances, acids, or oxidizing or corrosive
compounds in the bed or body of any vehicle transporting explosives.
コ Equip vehicles transporting explosives with not less than two Class 10 BC fire extinguishers for
on-post shipments. Place the extinguishers at strategic points so they are ready for immediate
use. Keep vehicles away from congested areas. Consider the parking congestion.
コ Operate vehicles transporting explosives with extreme care. Do not drive at a speed greater than
35 miles per hour. Make full stops at approaches to all railroad crossings and main highways.
Note. This does not apply to convoys or crossings protected by guards or highway workers
(flaggers).
コ Keep flames at least 50 feet from vehicles or storage points containing explosives.
Cargo (Explosives)
6-50. When transporting explosives, these precautions are followed:
コ Do not leave explosives unattended.
コ Do not mix live and inert (dummy) explosives.
コ Secure the load of explosives in the transport to prevent shifting during transport.
コ Do not transport blasting caps or other initiators in the same vehicles carrying explosives unless
absolutely necessary. Separate the blasting caps from other explosives if both blasting caps and
explosives must be carried in the same vehicle.
Note. Carry the caps in a closed metal container in the cab of the transport.
コ Do not allow anyone other than the primary and assistant operators to ride on or in a truck
transporting explosives. Do not refuel a vehicle while carrying explosives except in an
emergency.
Fire
6-51. If fire breaks out in a vehicle transporting explosives, these actions are followed:
コ Try to stop the vehicle away from any populated areas.
コ Stop traffic from both directions. Warn the vehicle drivers and passengers and occupants of
nearby buildings to keep at least 2,000 feet away from the fire.
コ Inform police, firefighters, and other emergency response personnel that the cargo is explosives.
コ Attempt to extinguish the fire with fire extinguishers, sand, dirt, or water if the fire involves only
the engine, cab, chassis, or tires. Stop fighting the fire and evacuate to a distance of at least
2,000 feet if the fire spreads to the body of the transport or the cargo.
コ Do not attempt to extinguish burning explosives without expert advice and assistance.
STORAGE SAFETY
6-52. Proper storage safety should be observed at all times. The paragraphs below discuss the storage
safety of permanent and temporary magazines and the use of temporary storage.
MAGAZINES
6-53. The two types of magazines are permanent and temporary. Although permanent magazines are
preferred, temporary or emergency magazines are frequently required when permanent construction is not
possible. FM 4-30.1 gives details on storage of explosives in magazines. The paragraphs below should be
considered when constructing magazines.
Permanent
6-54. The acceptability of magazine locations should be considered based on the safety requirements,
accessibility, dryness, and drainage. Safety and accessibility are the most important factors. An ideal
location is a hilly area where the height of the ground above the magazine provides a natural wall or barrier
to buildings, centers of communication, and other magazines in the area. Hillside bunkers are not desirable
because adequate ventilation and drainage are often difficult to achieve. To lessen the danger of fire, clear
brush and tall grass is cleared from the site.
6-55. All magazines should have a grounded, overhead lightning rod system. All metal parts (doors,
ventilators, window sashes, reinforcing steel, and so forth) are connected to buried conduits of copperplate
or graphite rods in several places. Guards are placed at all magazines to prevent unauthorized personnel
from gaining access to the magazine facilities.
6-56. Barricades are installed around the magazines to ensure that there is a substantial obstacle between
the magazines and the inhabited buildings. For certain explosives, effective natural or artificial barricades
reduce the required MSDs between magazines and railways and highways by one-half. The use of
barricades permit the storage of larger quantities of explosives in any given area. Although barricades help
protect magazines against explosives and bomb or shell fragments, they do not safeguard against pressure
damage. AR 385-64 and DA Pamphlet 385-64 give more specific guidance on barricades.
Temporary
6-57. When permanent-magazine construction is not possible, temporary magazines are created by placing
explosives on pallets to accommodate ventilation. The pallets are stored in a well-drained bunker. The
bunker is excavated in a dry area and is reverted with timber to prevent collapse. Alternatives are an
isolated building or a light, wooden-frame house with a wedge-type roof covered with corrugated iron or
tent canvas. Field-expedient storage facilities are marked on all four sides with signs (see AR 385-64 and
DA Pamphlet 385-64).
TEMPORARY STORAGE
6-58. When necessary, store limited supplies of explosives in covered ammunition shelters. To prevent fire
or explosion from being transmitted between shelters, ensure that the temporary facilities are separated
adequately. Piles of temporarily stored explosives should not contain more than 500 pounds each and are
spaced no closer than 140 feet. Explosive components are piled separately. Explosives, caps, and other
demolition material stored in training areas are kept in covered ammunition shelters and are under guard at
all times. The local safety SOPs, AR 385-64, and DA Pamphlet 385-64 are used as guides for temporary
storage operations.
Note. Any deviation from the requirement for separate storage of blasting caps and explosives
should be approved through the Director, United States Army Defense Ammunition Center,
McAlester, Oklahoma 74501.
CONCEPT
6-59. Destroying demolition materials is a unit commander’s decision. The purpose of this intentional
destruction is to prevent an enemy from capturing stockpiles of explosives. Whenever a commander orders
destruction, two primary considerations are site selection and safety precautions. EOD units are responsible
for destroying damaged or unserviceable explosives and demolition materials (see AR 75-14, FM 4-30.51,
and TM 43-0001-38). Explosive and nonexplosive demolition materials should be completely destroyed in
a combat zone. Essential components of sets and kits should be damaged to prevent complete assembly by
removal of undamaged components. Such destruction is a command decision based on the tactical
situation, the security classification of the demolition materials, their quantity and location, the facilities for
accomplishing destruction, and the time available. In general, burning and detonating or a combination of
both are the most effective means of destruction.
SITE SELECTION
6-60. The demolition materials’ destruction site is selected for its ability to provide the greatest obstruction
to enemy movement, but prevent hazards to friendly troops. Even in the fastest-paced operations, safety is
important and the appropriate safety precautions should be adhered to, if possible.
METHODS
6-61. Burning or detonating, in that order, are considered the most satisfactory methods for destroying
demolition materials to prevent enemy use. DA Pamphlet 385-64 and TM 9-1300-214 cover procedures for
explosives and ammunition destruction in greater detail.
BURNING
6-62. Packed and unpacked HE items are destroyed by burning. These explosives include linear, shape,
and block demolition charges; stick dynamite; detonating cord; firing devices; and timed blasting fuse.
Destroying blasting caps by burning them should not be attempted since they will detonate from extreme
heat. They should be separated from other explosives and destroyed by detonation. Personnel should not
attempt to extinguish burning explosives without expert advice and assistance. The following procedures
should be used for burning explosives:
コ Place blasting caps in piles separate from explosives, and destroy them by detonation. Ensure
that blasting caps are stored far enough away from the other explosives being burned to prevent
the burning explosives from detonating the blasting caps or vice versa.
コ Stack explosives in a pile over a layer of combustible material. Ensure that the piles do not
exceed 2,000 pounds or are no more than 3 inches thick.
コ Ignite the pile with a combustible train (excelsior or slow-burning propellant) of suitable length,
and take cover immediately. Calculate the MSD from the pile using Table 6-2, page 6-7. This
distance is never less than 300 meters.
コ Do not try to extinguish burning explosives without expert advice and assistance.
Note. Burning explosives cannot be extinguished by smothering them or drenching them. In fact,
smothering will probably cause an explosion.
DETONATION
6-63. The tactical situation, the commander’s intent, the lack of time, the explosive type, or safety
considerations may require an explosive to be detonated instead of burned. The following procedures
should be used for detonating explosives:
コ Establish a safety zone for missile and blast effect by computing the MSD required for the
amount of explosives to be detonated (Table 6-1, page 6-6).
コ Do not exceed the limitations of the disposal site. Make several smaller piles of explosives, and
stagger their detonating times instead of detonating one large pile of explosives.
コ Use a minimum of two initiation systems to detonate a pile of explosives.
コ Prime explosives every 4 to 5 feet when placing explosives in long rows or lines.
コ Ensure positive contact between primed charges and other explosives in the pile or row.
the host nations environmental standards. U.S. federal regulations are used only if the host nation’s
standards are less stringent.
Note. High-rise building demolition missions under combat conditions require significant
demolition planning, coordination, and expertise. A combat engineer has basic expertise to
understand many of the principles involved in demolishing such complex buildings but requires
a building demolition expert to assist in building a detailed plan. Each building requires case-by
case study and planning before detonation procedures. When such situations arise, the United
States Army Corps of Engineers explosive effects team should be contacted via the
TeleEngineering Operations Center (TEOC). The commander should not accept risk without
expert reachback assistance to accomplish the task. TeleEngineering is capable of addressing a
complex task that is encountered in the field. Soldiers can quickly send information through the
TeleEngineering kit via advanced communication links to the TEOC. The TEOC can tap the
required technical expertise through the Corps’s research laboratories, districts and divisions,
private industry, and academia to provide a quick answer to the task. In this task, the explosive
effects team would assist in assessing the design of the demolition plan, providing there is
telephonic, computer, or video teleconference reachback capabilities at the location. The TEOC
can be contacted by e-mail at <[email protected]>, on the Web at
<http://teleengineering.usace.army.mil/>, or by telephone at (601) 634-2735; and DSN
312-446-2735.
EXPLOSIVE EFFECT
7-2. When the explosive is detonated, the explosive material is instantaneously converted into a rapidly
expanded mass of gases. The explosive detonation will result in four fundamental effects that may affect
the breacher team and/or the surrounding areas—blast pressure, fragmentation, thermal effect, and
chemical poisoning.
Blast Pressure
7-3. Once the detonation occurs, a mass of expanding gas rolls outward in a circular pattern from the
point of detonation like a giant tidal wave, smashing and shattering any object in its path. The farther the
pressure wave travels from the point of detonation, the less power it possesses until it dwindles to nothing.
Blast pressure has two pressure phases—positive and negative.
コ Positive pressure phase. When the blast pressure wave is formed at the instant of detonation,
the pressure actually compresses the surrounding atmosphere. The layer of compressed air,
known as the shock front, is the leading edge of the positive pressure. The shock front is only a
fraction of an inch thick and is that part of the atmosphere that is compressed before it is set in
motion. As the shock front, followed by the positive pressure wave moves outward, it applies a
sudden shattering, hammering blow to any object in its path.
コ Negative pressure phase. As the shock front moves outward, it pushes the surrounding air away
from the point of detonation. This outward compressing and pushing of air forms a partial
vacuum at the point of detonation. When the shock front and positive pressure has dissipated, the
broad partial vacuum causes the compressed and displaced atmosphere to reverse its movement
and rush inward to fill the void. This reverse movement of air is known as the negative pressure
phase. The displaced air rushing back toward the point of detonation has mass, power, and great
velocity.
7-4. In addition to having two pressure phases, the blast effect creates other effects that may cause major
problems for the breacher team. This is known as blast pressure phenomenon. Preparation would include
being equipped with suitable protection. Blast pressure phenomenon also includes—
コ Dynamic pressure. Dynamic pressure is the transitional pressure exerted on an object by the
blast. This is the pressure felt and the damage caused by the impact of the shock front with the
object. A person standing in the open, in the line of travel of a blast wave, would be exposed to
dynamic pressure.
コ Incidental pressure. Incident pressure is the pressure measured at 90° to the blast front
direction of travel. A person standing behind a barrier, wall, building, or so forth, which is in the
line of travel of the blast shock front, would be exposed to incident pressure.
コ Reflective pressure. Reflective pressure is a rapid buildup of pressure that occurs when a shock
front strikes any surface in the line of travel and bounces off. There is a rapid amplification of
pressure as a result of the piling up and reflection of the wave off the surface. This reflection
results even though the exposed surface may fail or collapse. The pressure wave impacting the
surface will reflect at 90° angles and at twice the strength regardless of the surface material.
Additionally, if the wave is reflected in a corner, the pressure can quadruple.
コ Residual pressure. Residual pressure is the amount of overpressure built-up in a confined space
from the result of a detonation. A detonation results in the production of a huge quantity of gas,
which creates pressure within a confined space.
Fragmentation
7-5. When an explosive charge is detonated, shattering fragments of the casing and any item located in
close proximity to the charge will be hurled outward at high speeds. Fragmentation may be a major hazard
that Soldiers should be aware of and protect against.
7-6. Items that may cause fragmentation hazards include blasting caps, charge construction materials,
prop sticks, doorknobs, doorjambs, and so forth. These fragments may not only be harmful to immediate
personnel, but also to the surroundings.
Thermal Effect
7-7. The thermal effect produced by the detonation of an urban charge is usually seen as a bright flash or
fireball. This is normally not a significant hazard unless highly combustible materials engulf the breacher
team.
Chemical Poisoning
7-8. The chemicals used in explosives, the detonation itself, and/or the toxic gases from building
materials may be poisonous. When explosives are used in enclosed areas, appropriate respiratory protection
must be worn.
IMPACT
7-9. Impact injuries can cause serious injury and can be fatal. The two types of impact injuries are
acceleration and deceleration.
コ Acceleration. Acceleration injuries can be produced in two ways. First, the body or a body part
is impacted by a projectile or fragment. This is called blunt trauma. Second, the victim is hit with
the blast pressure wave and is accelerated through the air.
コ Deceleration. Deceleration injuries occur when an accelerated victim impacts a surface. Injuries
can range from lacerations to massive brain injury.
DEBRIS
7-10. Debris is anything that impedes movement through the entry point. For example, doors lying inside
or outside of the entry point or portions of the door frame or other parts of the opening that has been created
by the explosions.
SAFETY
7-11. There are several measures that must be taken into consideration when dealing with explosive urban
entry charges. These measures include calculating the MSD, the fragmentation distance, the charge
placement, and proper positioning.
FRAGMENTATION DISTANCE
7-13. Fragmentation and missile hazards near the detonation of HEs must be reduced to an acceptable
level. The safe fragmentation distance far exceeds the safe overpressure distance. Using just the safe
fragmentation distance will not allow an expedient entry. It is the breachers responsibility to recommend
measures to protect the team from fragmentation and missile hazards.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-14. Breachers should place the charge so that the fragmentation and missile hazards will be thrown away
from the team and/or structures that should not be damaged (if possible).
PROPER POSITIONING
7-15. Proper positioning is the most important factor in reducing hazards to personnel. The number of
personnel should be limited to the absolute minimum in the immediate vicinity of the detonation. Any
available cover should be taken advantage of during the detonation or when a breacher blanket is not
available.
FORMULA
7-17. NEW equals the total pounds of explosives expressed in TNT equivalent. The formula is—
where—
qty – quantity
wt = weight
RE = relative effectiveness
New = net explosive weight (or TNT equivalent)
This formula must be worked for each explosive type used and all of the products added together for the
total NEW of a charge. See Table 7-1.
Note. Some explosives are listed in grain per foot or in grams. These must be converted to
pounds, multiplied by the RE factor for TNT, then added together to determine the NEW
equivalent to TNT.
Note. If in pounds, leave in pounds, multiply (if necessary) by the package weight, and then
multiply by the RE factor. If not in pounds, convert to pounds using the formulas above,
multiply by the package weight (if necessary), multiply by the RE factor, and then add all
explosives together; this will be the NEW (equivalent to TNT).
DANGER
The standoff formula in this chapter references overpressure safe
distances. The formula does not account for fragmentation,
decibels, or heat. The breacher needs to take other precautions to
mitigate hazards. Failure to comply may cause death or personal
injury.
RE Factors
Item Explosive RE Factor
FLSC CH-6 1.50
Sheet explosive (composition C2) PETN based 1.66
Detonating cord PETN 1.66
M6 and M7 blasting caps RDX 1.60
Composition C4 M112 RDX based 1.34
Dynamite RDX 0.92
Booster PETN based 1.66
Composition C4 M186 PETN/RDX 1.14
NEW Formula
Explosives Formula
Composition C4 (M112) 1.25 lbs per lb x 1.34 =
block
Composition C4 (M186) lb x 1.14 =
Dynamite lb x 0.92 =
TNT Needs no conversion
FLSC 4-ft sections ft x gr x 1.50 =
Detonating cord ft x gr x 1.66 =
M6 and M7 blasting caps N x 13.5 x 1.6 = 21.6
Sheet explosive (L x W) T x 15.4 x 1.66 =
Booster, 20 g 20 x 15.4 x 1.66 =
MDI Cap Weigh (this table takes in account for all conversions)*
MDI Cap Converted Grain Weight
M11 19
M12 13
M13 13
M14 delay 16
M15 delay 15 and 3
M16 19
M18 delay 16
M19 dual (two caps) 35
M21 19
M23 19
MDI booster (includes detonating Converted grain weight
cord)
M151 87
M152 197
Where—g = gram gr = grain L = length N = number T = thickness W = width
Note. The MSD with shielding is half the distance without shielding and is rounded up to
the next whole foot. It takes 3.4 pounds per square inch to rupture an eardrum. With proper
hearing protection, use 4 pounds per square inch as the maximum when calculating for blast
overpressure. Four pounds per square inch has a K factor of 18 as shown in Table 7-2.
Pounds per square inch less than 4 may be used. For example, 2 will have a K factor of 30
and you will receive less overpressure.
WARNING
This standoff is only assumed safe when proper hearing
protection is used. Failure to comply could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment. It takes
3.4 pounds per square inch to rupture an eardrum, 40 pounds
per square inch to collapse a lung, and 220 pounds per
square inch to loose a limb.
Table 7-3. MSD for K Factor of 18 Representing 4.5 Pounds Per Square Inch
Note. When using this table, if the NEW (carry out two places past the decimal) falls between
the two numbers depicted in column 1, use the next higher number in column 1 for determining
the safe blast distance with or without shielding in columns 4 and 5.
7-19. Use the following example problems and Table 7-3, page 7-7, (with formula) to obtain the NEW
and the standoff for overpressure:
Example 1. Calculate the standoff. You are given one 5-foot piece of 50-grain-per-foot
detonating cord, one 12-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord, and one M11
blasting cap. What is the NEW and the standoff?
Example 2. Calculate the standoff. You are given a 42-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot
detonating cord and one M11 blasting cap. What is the NEW and the standoff?
Example 3. Calculate the standoff. You are given a 14-foot piece of 50-grain-per-foot
detonating cord, two M112 composition C4 blocks, and one M11 blasting cap. What is the
NEW and the standoff?
Example 4. Calculate the standoff. You are given a 32-foot piece of 50-grain-per-foot
detonating cord, six M112 composition C4 blocks, one 12-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot
detonating cord, and one M11 blasting cap. What is the NEW and the standoff?
Answer:
6 x 1.25 x 1.34 = 10.05 lbs of TNT (already in pounds)
32 ft x 50 x 1.66 = 2,656 gr of TNT
1 ft x 50 x 1.66 = 83 gr of TNT
Note. It is recommended that both ends of all lengths of detonating cord be taped.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-21. Explosive materials required include 21 feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord (this number
may vary depending on the door type; one 80-inch piece of detonating cord should be added for
security doors).
7-22. Nonexplosive materials required include 2-inch pressure-sensitive tape (duct tape) and double-
sided tape.
Note. Use three strips of detonating cord for all doors except extremely rugged security
doors. Use four strips when a very secure structure is encountered using security-type doors
of solid wood, such as an oak blank or ribbed metal.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-23. The following steps are used to construct a detonating cord linear charge:
コ Step 1. Cut a piece of double-sided tape 80 inches long. Peel one side, and lay the
tape flat on a table with the sticky side up.
コ Step 2. Cut and place a 92-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord strip down the
center of the double-sided tape, keeping the detonating cord as straight as possible. Ensure
that one end of the detonating cord is even with the end of the tape.
コ Step 3. Cut two 80-inch lengths of detonating cord (three for heavier metal doors) and place
one on each side of the 92-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord. Ensure that the
detonating cord is tight against each other for the entire length.
コ Step 4. Use duct tape, and cover the detonating cord and tape.
コ Step 5. Form a pigtail to aid in priming using the end of the 92-inch length of detonating
cord.
コ Step 6. Use duct tape to make a buddy tab (folded tape) at the top of the charge, and
continue to run the duct tape down the length of the paper covering. This ensures easier
separation of the end of the tape and its adhesive backing.
コ Step 7. Roll the charge, starting at the bottom with the paper side inward. This ensures the
ease of charge placement and keeps the tape covering from cracking or coming off.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-24. The charge can be placed on the hinge side, doorknob side, or in the center of the door. If placed
toward the door edge, do not place it closer than 4 inches from the edge. Exact placements will
determine the result of the cut. The following steps are used to place a charge:
コ Step 1. Peel off the double-sided tape backing when placing the charge on the target, and
attach the charge to the target from the top to the bottom.
コ Step 2. Pull the buddy tab down slightly from the top of the charge, and begin attaching the
tape to the door.
コ Step 3. Place the charge straight up and down (Figure 7-2) on the door. Place the charge as
close to the mechanism as possible to cut the door and allow entry.
Note. When placing the charge on the door locking mechanism side, not enough space may
be available to place the charge directly over the locking mechanism running parallel to the
doorframe.
コ Step 4. Prime the charge after it is attached to the door. This makes it much easier to unroll
the charge during emplacement without the shock tube becoming twisted.
Note. Placing the charge during wet conditions may cause the adhesive tape to be
ineffective. A secondary mounting method must be available if the tape backing does not
stick. Staples may be used for wooden doors and prop sticks may be used for any door type.
If time is available and the situation allows, cut any additional length off the charge to fit the desired
cut.
Explosive
Target
(50-grain-per-foot detonating cord)
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-30. The following explosive and nonexplosive materials are required:
コ Explosive materials.
ト 12-foot wraps of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
ト Five wraps for an exterior wall (exterior lap siding, studs, or sheetrock) (four 12-foot pieces
of detonating and one 13-foot piece of detonating cord).
ト Six wraps for a roof (shingle or plywood) (five 12-foot pieces of detonating cord and one
13-foot piece of detonating cord).
ト Eight wraps for an unfilled cinder block wall.
ト Appropriate priming system.
コ Nonexplosive materials.
ト Duct tape.
ト Two E-type silhouettes.
ト One prop stick, if required.
ト Zip ties.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-31. The following steps are used to construct the charge:
コ Step 1. Secure two E-silhouette targets. Cut one head off at the shoulders. Leave one head on at
what will be the charge bottom.
コ Step 2. Position the targets back-to-back with the green sides facing each other. Tape, with duct
tape, the targets together along the bottom edge of the two targets.
コ Step 3. Punch three holes, evenly spaced along the bottom of the targets, 1/4 to 1/2 inch up from
the bottom. Thread a zip tie through each hole, and tighten enough so as to leave a 1/2-inch gap.
This creates a hinge that allows the charge to fold easily.
コ Step 4. Cut a 2- by 5-inch rectangular hole 1 to 2 inches from the side and center through both
target pieces to create a carrying handle for the charge while it is folded.
コ Step 5. Open the hinge that was created, ensuring that the E silhouette with the head attached is
at the bottom.
コ Step 6. Create a prop stick holder by cutting a U shape 3 inches long by 4 inches wide about 4 to
6 inches in from the headless end. Ensure that the opening of the U faces the bottom of the
charge.
コ Step 7. Punch three evenly spaced holes about 1/4 inch from the edge along the side of each E
silhouette. Thread the zip ties through the holes of the E silhouette. Fasten the zip ties just tight
enough to stay closed. Ensure that the fastening head of the zip ties is over the edge of the E
silhouette so they will not interfere with the adhesion of the charge to the breaching target.
コ Step 8. Punch two holes in the top and bottom of the E silhouette in the same manner as the
holes punched in the sides. Ensure that these holes align where the shoulders of the target turn to
form a straight edge.
コ Step 9. Punch a pair of holes in the center of the head on the bottom of the E silhouette about
1/2-inch apart.
コ Step 10. Thread one zip tie down and back through the two holes in the head of the E silhouette.
Fasten the zip ties just tight enough to stay closed.
Note. Zip ties must be loose enough to thread multiple loops of detonating cord through them. If
zip ties are not available, a 3- to 4-inch piece of double-sided tape can be used. Tape over the
detonating cord with duct tape.
Note. Work each wrap of the loop from the center of the E silhouette towards the outside. Do not
feed through the zip tie on the head at this time. The type of obstacle construction material
determines the number of wraps. Five wraps of detonating cord for interior walls, studs, and
sheetrock; six wraps of detonating cord for roof shingles and plywood; and eight wraps of
detonating cord for block walls.
コ Step 2. When the determined number of wraps has been completed, feed the running end
through the zip tie in the head at the bottom of the E silhouette leaving a 1-foot tail.
コ Step 3. Pull enough detonating cord from the standing end (spool) to match the length of the
running end. Cut the standing end from the spool.
コ Step 4. Feed the cut end through the zip tie in the head in the same manner as before.
コ Step 5. Tighten the zip ties around the E silhouette working from the same point where the feed
started. Pull the slack towards the loose zip ties.
コ Step 6. Tighten the zip tie in the head.
コ Step 7. Cut off the ends of all the zip ties as close to the fastening head as possible.
Note. Tape the exposed ends of the zip ties to cover any sharp ends created by cutting them off.
7-33. The following steps are used to construct a charge attachment system:
コ Step 1. Cut two pieces of double-sided tape 6 to 8 inches long.
コ Step 2. Remove the cover from one side of the tape. Attach one piece to the top of the charge
just below the prop stick U on the backside of the charge.
コ Step 3. Cover the protective cover of the remaining side with waterproof tape leaving a 1-inch
overhang folded against it to create a pull tab.
コ Step 4. Attach the second piece on the bottom of the charge in the center of the shoulder area on
the backside of the charge. Create a pull tab for this strip in the same manner as above.
コ Step 5. Cut a nonmetallic prop stick (such as a broom handle that is 2 by 4 inches) or a tree
branch to the proper size to hold the charge against the target.
WARNING
A prop stick may produce secondary fragmentation up to
100 meters to the rear. The doorknob and locking mechanism are
missile hazards. Failure to comply could result in immediate
personal injury or damage to equipment.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-34. The charge on the target with the E-silhouette head is placed as a standoff from the ground. The
charge is attached to the target with the head side down.
コ Remove the protective cover from the double-sided tape using the pull tab created during the
charge construction.
コ Push the charge backing material, adhesive side down, against the target ensuring that the
double-sided tape is adhered to the target.
コ Place the charge centered on the doors unless the doors are over 8 feet tall, then place the charge
about 1 foot above the floor.
WARNING
Placing the charge higher than 1 foot above the floor will create a
tripping hazard as a result of the blast. Failure to comply could
result in immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
Note. Use a nonmetallic prop stick for heavier charges. Place one end of the stick against the
charge under the flap created during construction. Place the other end on the ground, and push it
towards the target to prop the charge against the target.
コ Place the charge on walls about 1 foot above the floor. Locate the wall studs before placement of
the charge.
Note. The charge is 19 inches wide when constructed from an E silhouette. The center of the
charge should be centered between the studs regardless of the stud spacing. Wall studs are
normally spaced at 16 to 24 inches on center.
WARNING
A prop stick may produce secondary fragmentation up to 100
meters. Failure to follow proper procedures could result in
immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
CONCRETE CHARGE
7-36. The concrete charge uses the blast principle to breach concrete up to 19 inches thick. The information
in the paragraphs below should be applied.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-37. Concrete charge material required include 50-grains-per-foot detonating cord (Table 7-4, page 7-12).
Each wrap of the 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord should be 12 feet long. Material requirements include―
コ Explosive materials.
ト Six blocks of composition C4.
ト Thirty-two feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
ト A dual-firing system.
コ Nonexplosive materials.
ト Backing material.
ト Tape.
ト A prop stick.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-38. The following steps are used to construct a concrete charge:
コ Step 1. Cut a 12-foot length of detonating cord (this will be the main line). Cut and tie the
remaining detonating cord to this line.
コ Step 2. Cut 12 pieces of detonating cord, each piece 18 to 20 inches long. Tie Uli knots on the
main line.
コ Step 3. Tape a block of composition C4 to the knots once the Uli knots are tied (one knot on
each end of the block). Ensure that the Uli knots slide if adjustments need to be made at the
target.
コ Step 4. Space the blocks evenly, but no more than 12 inches apart.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-39. The following steps are used to place a concrete charge:
コ Step 1. Place the charge flat against the target.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-42. Explosive materials required include 5 feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord. For priming, add 1
foot of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
7-43. Nonexplosive materials required include—
コ A medium 1- by 18-inch strip of Goodyear™ 330B rubber, belted, conveyer belt rubber.
Note. If these items are not available, the medium must be a material that will not disintegrate
when the detonation occurs, such as a truck mud flap or polystyrene cutting board.
コ Double-sided tape.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-44. The following steps are used to construct a rubber-strip charge (Figure 7-5):
コ Step 1. Cut a strip of rubber, or whatever is being used as a medium, 18 inches long by 1 inch
wide.
コ Step 2. Cut the detonating cord into two 18-inch strips and one 30-inch strip.
コ Step 3. Place the 30-inch piece of detonating cord in the center running lengthwise down the
rubber allowing 6 inches to hang over the 1-inch edge.
コ Step 4. Place an 18-inch strip on each side of the 30-inch piece of detonating cord to cover the
rubber.
コ Step 5. Tape both ends and the center with one to two wraps of electrical tape or equivalent-
sized strips of duct tape.
コ Step 6. Fold 6 inches of the detonating cord upon itself, and tape to make a 3-inch priming
pigtail.
コ Step 7. Place strips of double-sided tape on the rubber side of the charge. Use duct tape to make
a buddy tab (folded tape) at the top of the charge, and continue to run the duct tape down the
length of the paper covering to prevent the double-sided tape from tearing when the paper
backing is removed.
ト Using the bight to attach the initiating system using an M9 or taping the blasting caps
directly to the bight formed with the detonating cord.
コ Step 3. Prepare to detonate the charge by—
ト Standing at a safe distance from the charge as determined by the breach team leader.
ト Firing the charge upon command from the breach team leader.
WARNING
The doorjamb will be the protective shielding when the charge is
fired. There is a chance that, if the charge can be seen, injuries
could occur by blasting fragmentation. Failure to follow proper
procedures could result in immediate personal injury or damage
to equipment.
Note. It is not necessary for the entire length of the charge to be touching the window stile. If the
charge is placed on a double-hung window, the bottom portion can be pushed in to touch the
inner window stile or it can be left hanging. The results will be the same.
コ Step 2. Add additional tape, if necessary, to secure the charge to the window.
コ Step 3. Back off to a safe distance, and initiate the charge.
コ Step 4. Be prepared to break and rake any glass left in the window frame after detonating.
Note. The explosive will push the medium through the target, removing the glass from the
bottom of the window. The window will fall down under its own weight.
コ Be prepared to break and rake any glass left in the frame after the charge detonates, since the
commercial window is large.
Note. If attacking a larger window, two charges placed end to end in the corner may be needed.
WATER CHARGE
7-50. This charge (Figure 7-7, page 7-20) is primarily used on metal or steel doors. The charge should be
centered on the door to buckle it, causing the locking mechanism to slide out of the strike plate. The fluids
in the intravenous (IV) bags act as force and tamp devices. When placed on solid wooden doors, it must be
placed over the locking mechanism.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-51. The following explosive and nonexplosive materials are required:
コ Explosive materials.
ト 11 feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord or 12 feet with a priming system.
ト A priming system of your choice.
コ Nonexplosive materials.
ト 550 cord.
ト Double-sided tape or breachers tape.
ト Suitable backing material (cardboard).
ト Duct tape and electrical tape.
ト Prop stick.
ト Two each, 500- or 1,000-milliliter IV bags.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-52. The following steps are used to construct a water impulse charge:
コ Step 1. Prepare the material for charge construction.
ト Do not remove the outer lining from two IV bags. This provides added protection to the IV
bags to prevent leaking and will not affect the result of the charge.
ト Cut a piece of backing material 4 by 8 inches or equal to the size of the IV bag.
Note. Backing material should be the size of the IV bag. Any heavy cardboard will work. The
backing material provides a flat surface area to attach the charge to the target.
ト Tape the folded detonating cord tightly around the 3-foot section with electrical tape, and
then cover it with waterproof tape.
ト Tape the backing material to one of the two IV bags.
Note. Ensure that the backing material maintains a flat face and is not curved from taping. If
curved, it will reduce the charge-to-target contact area.
Note. Taping the detonating cord in place will keep it from pulling out as the charge is
constructed.
ト Place the second IV bag facing the same direction on top of the first, and tape it tightly to
the first bag. Ensure that the detonating cord is sandwiched between the two IV bags.
Protect the IV bags by taping them entirely with duct tape.
Note. Ensure that the backing material remains flat so that the breachers tape or double-sided
tape can be placed on the charge to secure the charge to the target.
Note. This bridle will allow the charge to hang from a prop stick.
ト Place one end of the cord along one side of the charge. Secure it to the charge with duct
tape just above the knot.
ト Run the tape halfway around the charge. Form a loop with the 550 cord, and place the
opposite end along the other side of the charge. Secure it to the charge by running the tape
the rest of the way around the charge and over the 550 cord just below the knot.
ト Fold the ends of the cord below the knots back over the tape, and cover the cord ends with
more tape.
Note. The reversing of the cord will ensure that it does not pull out from under the tape.
ト Cover the entire face of the backing material with double-sided tape.
ト Peel back the protective cover, and run a strip of duct tape across the top and bottom one-
half inch of the double-sided tape. Run this strip of tape onto the charge.
Note. This strip ensures that the duct tape does not come off in adverse weather.
ト Tape the two free ends of the detonating cord together to allow for the priming system
hook-up. Use electrical tape at the ends and about 3 inches up on the detonating cord.
ト Cut a prop stick to an appropriate length, and notch it to hold the 550 cord.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-53. The following steps should be used to attach the charge to the target:
コ Step 1. Cut a prop stick to an appropriate length, and notch it in the middle to hold the 550 cord.
コ Step 2. Attach the charge to the target using one of the following methods:
ト Inward-opening wooden doors. Place the charge by setting it on top of the doorknob and
prop it up with a stick.
Note. This allows for more support of the charge with the capability to defeat the door even if it
has a dead bolt.
ト Metal doors. Place the charge centered both horizontally and vertically on the door
(Figure 7-8).
Note. The normal tendency is to place the charge too high. It takes practice to ensure the proper
placement of the charge. When fired, the hydraulic pressure buckles the center of the door
causing the locking and closing mechanism to slide out of the strike plate and opening the door.
In most cases, it will rip the entire door from the frame.
Note. A metal security door is constructed of 14- or 16-gauge steel and contains steel ribs
running vertically between the door panels. A centered charge will not defeat this door because
the ribs strengthen the door and keep it from buckling. Placing the charge next to the locking
mechanism defeats the locking mechanism and allows the door to open.
ト Outward-opening doors. Place the charge centered horizontally and vertically on the door.
(As with the inward opening door, the door will buckle. In this case the door will bounce
off the door jam and open.)
ト Screen doors. Place the charge directly on the screen door in the position it would be
placed for the door type located being the screen door.
DANGER
A prop stick may produce secondary fragmentation up to 100
meters to the rear. The doorknob and locking mechanism are
missile hazards. Failure to follow proper procedures may cause
death or permanent injury.
C-CHARGE
7-55. The C-charge can be used to open a solid wood door or a metal door. The charge cuts the lock out of
the door.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-56. Explosive materials required include 6.5 feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord. Nonexplosive
materials required include duct tape, cardboard, and double-sided tape.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-57. The following steps are used to construct a C-charge (Figure 7-9):
コ Step 1. Prepare the material for charge construction.
ト Cut the backing material in about an 8-inch square.
ト Apply double-sided tape along three edges of the backing material forming a C shape.
Ensure that the closed end of the C is in line with one edge of the backing material.
Note. Leave the protective cover on the outside of the tape until ready to apply the detonating
cord.
ト Cut the required amount of detonating cord long enough to form a C on the outer edge of
the C created with the double-sided tape.
Note. To help with the measurement for the correct length of detonating cord, lay the first piece
of cord along the outer edge of the C created by the double-sided tape. Follow the outer edge of
the C starting at the top of the opening. Travel along the outer edge of the backing material and
return to the bottom of the opening. Cut off the first piece.
ト Use the length of the first piece of detonating cord, and cut a template. Cut the remaining
number of pieces of detonating cord for the charge.
ト Cut a 30-inch length of detonating cord, and set it aside. Use this piece to prime the charge.
コ Step 2. Attach the explosive.
ト Remove the protective cover from the double-sided tape, and press the first piece of
detonating cord in place along the outside edge of the double-sided tape. Form a C shape,
ensuring that the closed end of the C is in line with the back edge of the backing material by
pressing them one piece at a time inside the previous piece working towards the center.
ト Place the correct number of detonating cord pieces (4 to 10).
ト Tape the detonating cord to the double-sided tape with electrical tape every 2 to 4 inches,
starting about 2 inches in from the opened end of the C.
ト Trim the ends of the detonating cord evenly on both sides.
コ Step 3. Prime the charge.
ト Form a bight in the 30-inch piece of detonating cord previously cut by bending it in half.
ト Connect the two lengths of detonating cord by wrapping a piece of electrical tape around
both lengths about 4 inches from the end of the bight.
ト Line the ends of the two lengths of detonating cord up with the ends of the detonating cord
that make up the charge. Prime the charge by laying the lengths of detonating cord on top of
the charge and holding it in place with duct tape.
ト Cover all the detonating cord with waterproof tape. Ensure that the detonating cord is
completely covered with the tape.
コ Step 4. Construct a charge attachment system.
ト Ensure that the charge is facing up, and mark a spot on the backing material in the center of
the C about 2 1/5 inches from the edge of the backing material with the opened side of the
C.
ト Make cuts 2 to 3 inches long forming a star at the spot marked on the backing material.
(This will form an area to press the charge over the doorknob.)
CAUTION
Do not cut closer than 1 inch from the straight edge of the charge.
Personal injury or damage to equipment may result from long-term
failure to follow correct procedures.
ト Apply double-sided tape to the back of the charge on three sides of the backing material
forming a C in the same manner as the front side.
ト Apply waterproof tape to the protective cover of the double-sided tape. Cut the waterproof
tape the same width as the double-sided tape so it does not overlap and stick to the backing
material. Extend the waterproof tape about 1 inch past the edge on the topside of the C
opening, and fold it back against itself forming a pull tab.
Note. This will allow quick removal of the protective cover from the double-sided tape so the
charge can be stuck to its target.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-58. The charge is placed on the doorknob or locking mechanism (Figure 7-10, page 7-26). The charge is
secured in place with double-sided tape. The detonating cord must be held firmly against the surface of the
door. The charge should be attached to the target by—
コ Removing the protective cover from the double-sided tape just before placing the charge.
コ Pushing the star previously cut in the backing material, adhesive side down, over the doorknob.
Ensure that the open side of the C faces the door edge.
コ Pressing the charge tightly against the door ensuring that the double-sided tape is adhered to the
door.
DOUGHNUT CHARGE
7-60. The doughnut charge (Figure 7-11) can open a solid wood door or a metal door. The charge cuts the
lock out of the door and is the only interior breaching charge.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-61. Explosive materials required include 42 inches of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord. Nonexplosive
materials required include duct tape.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-62. The following steps are used to construct a doughnut charge:
コ Step 1. Cut one 18-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
コ Step 2. Cut one 24-inch piece of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
コ Step 3. Use a 24-inch piece of detonating cord to tie an Uli knot (5 wrap) onto the 18-inch piece
of detonating cord. Fold that same 18-inch piece of detonating cord to form a loop. Use electrical
tape to tape the ends of the detonating cord together.
コ Step 4. Use a piece of duct tape, and make a sliding tape knot on the detonating cord loop. To do
this, take a 6-inch strip of tape, fold a 2-inch section over upon itself to create a nonstick surface,
and wrap the tape around the detonating cord. Continue wrapping until the tape is finished.
Ensure that the tape knot slides easily on the detonating cord loop. Finally, slide the tape toward
the ends of the loop to provide enough room to slide the loop over a doorknob.
コ Step 5. Ensure that both the Uli knot and tape slide freely.
コ Step 6. Construct and attach a priming system at the running ends of the loop.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-63. The following steps are used to place the doughnut charge on the target:
コ Step 1. Loop the charge over the doorknob.
コ Step 2. Slide the large Uli knot to one side of the detonating cord loop.
コ Step 3. Slide the knot to the side if the detonating cord loop has a natural bend, which will allow
the natural bend to curve toward the door.
コ Step 4. Place the detonating cord loop over the doorknob so that the Uli knot is between the
doorknob and the doorjamb.
コ Step 5. Position the Uli knot over the throw of the knob.
コ Step 6. Slide the tape knot toward the loop so that the loop is tightened onto the doorknob.
コ Step 7. Place the natural bend of the detonating cord toward the door to ensure that the blasting
cap is pushed into the door, providing the protection of the doorjamb between the breacher and
the charge.
コ Step 8. Take cover, and initiate the priming system.
Note. This is the only breaching charge that is direct-primed (no detonating cord loop). To
reduce the NEW (this is an internal charge), this charge is single-primed.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-67. Explosive materials required include 18 feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord. For a detonating
cord loop, add 1 foot of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
7-68. Nonexplosive materials required include—
コ Duct tape.
コ Electrical tape.
コ Three 1- by 5-inch pieces of flat rubber (or suitable material, such as a material that is able to
convert the blast dynamic pressure into impulse pressure without disintegrating). For example, a
truck mud flap, a plastic cutting board, or a truck tire.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-69. The following steps are used to construct a Uli knot slider charge:
コ Step 1. Use a sharp knife to cut three 1- by 5-inch strips of rubber.
コ Step 2. Cut one 8-foot piece of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
Note. Testing has found that 96 inches will cover most standard and nonstandard doors.
コ Step 4. Cut the remaining 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord into three equal length pieces.
Ensure that each piece is 24 inches long.
コ Step 5. Use electrical tape or duct tape to secure four 5-inch pieces of detonating cord onto one
side of a 1- by 5-foot strip of rubber. Ensure that an untaped area is left on the top center of the
detonating cord (where the Uli knot will lay). Repeat this step for the other two pieces of rubber.
コ Step 6. Use the 24-inch pieces of detonating cord to tie three Uli knots onto the 8-foot piece of
detonating cord. Ensure that the Uli knots slide freely on the 8-foot section of detonating cord.
コ Step 7. Secure the Uli knots to the rubber pieces with tape.
コ Step 8. Cut three 1- by 5-inch pieces of double-sided tape, and attach them to the bottom of the
three charge bodies. Ensure that the buddy tabs are made for ease of removal of the tape
backing.
コ Step 9. Tie an overhand knot in one end of the 8-foot piece of detonating cord to prevent the
charge bodies from sliding off.
コ Step 10. Fold 6 inches of the other end of the 8-foot length of detonating cord upon itself, and
tape it to make a 3-inch priming pigtail.
CHARGE PLACEMENT
7-70. Depending on the situation, remove the protective backing either in the safe area or en route to the
target. Place the Uli knot slider charge on the target in the following manner:
コ Place the charge bodies on the door parallel to the hinges on an outward-opening door (hinges
exposed).
コ Place the charge bodies on the door as close to the suspected hinge positions as possible on an
inward opening door (hinges not exposed). Typical hinge placement on doors is as follows:
ト Top hinge—about 7 to 9 inches or one hand length down from the top.
ト Center hinge—centered between the top and bottom hinge, about one hand height above the
doorknob.
ト Bottom hinge—about 10 inches up from the bottom.
Note. When encountering entrances that have screen or storm doors in front of the main door,
place the charge bodies on the screen or storm door so that the medium will impact the main
door next to the main door hinges. The intent is not to defeat the screen or storm door. It is
irrelevant as to which side the hinges are on. The attack is on the main door. The only real
difference is that there is now a standoff created by the screen or storm door, and greater care
will have to be used in the placement of the charge bodies in order to hit the target points.
FENCE CHARGE
7-72. The fence charge (Figure 7-13) is used against heavy-gauge-metal fence material, such as chain link.
This charge will work on other fence materials to create a hole for an assault element.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-73. Explosive and nonexplosive material required includes—
コ Explosive material.
ト 14 feet of 50-grain-per-foot detonating cord.
ト 4 M112 composition C4 blocks.
コ Nonexplosive material.
ト 2 treble hooks or nails.
ト 4 inches of surgical tubing or a thick rubber band.
ト Electrical tape.
ト Duct tape.
CHARGE CONSTRUCTION
7-74. The following steps are used to construct a fence charge:
コ Step 1. Cut four 21-inch pieces of detonating cord (this should leave one remaining 7-foot piece
of detonating cord).
コ Step 2. Cut off 1 foot of detonating cord to use as a priming bite, leaving one 6-foot piece.
コ Step 3. Use the four pieces of detonating cord, and tie four separate Uli knots onto the 6-foot
piece of detonating cord.
コ Step 4. Tie an overhand knot at one end of the 6-foot strand of detonating cord, ensuring that
there is an additional 2 to 3 inches of detonating cord from the knot to the end of the detonating
cord.
Note. This provides an explosive area to secure a treble hook or nail. The knot prevents any
explosives from sliding off of the main line. This end is called the top end.
コ Step 5. Take the end of the detonating cord without the knot, and fold it over to form a priming
bite. Secure it firmly with electrical tape (called the bottom end).
コ Step 6. Cut each M112 block lengthwise, making two 1- by 1- by 11-inch pieces out of each
block (four half blocks total). Cover the cut piece with duct tape to keep the composition C4
from falling apart. Leave one end of each piece uncovered. (This is where the 5-wrap Uli knot
will be attached.)
コ Step 7. Place the first composition C4 block onto the detonating cord touching the overhand
knot. Position the Uli knot on the composition C4 at the bottom edge. Cut out a notch for the Uli
knot. Place the excess composition C4 around the Uli knot before taping to the main line. Ensure
that it is deep enough so that the main line of detonating cord is at least flush with the
composition C4. Firmly tape the entire composition C4 block to the Uli knot and detonating
cord. Ensure that the Uli knot slides freely.
コ Step 8. Position the Uli knot as the previous one, and tape the entire block in place no more than
5 inches below the first composition C4 block position and the second composition C4 block.
Continue this procedure with the remaining composition C4 blocks and Uli knots.
コ Step 9. Use tape to attach a treble hook to the top end of the detonating cord on the composition
C4 side. Ensure that this is secure enough to hold the entire charge with tension placed on it. If
using a nail, bend the nail to a 45° angle, and secure it in place. Ensure that the hook points
toward the bottom end of the charge.
コ Step 10. Secure one end of the surgical tubing or rubber band to the detonating cord just below
the bottom-composition C4 block.
コ Step 11. Attach a second hook or nail to the surgical tubing or rubber band. Use the nails or
hooks to secure the charge to the fence.
MATERIALS REQUIRED
7-78. The following are the materials required for an MDI:
コ Explosive materials (such as M19, M81, M11, M12, M13, M21, or M23).
コ Nonexplosive materials (such as electrical tape, string, or rubber bands).
Note. Use the M19 for the initiation system. When the M19 is not available, construct an
initiation system.
CONSTRUCTION
7-79. Use the following steps when constructing an MDI initiation system:
コ Step 1. Turn the screw cap of the M81 fuse igniters several turns counterclockwise, and remove
the shipping plugs from the igniters.
コ Step 2. Cut off the sealed end of the M11, M12, M13, M21, or M23 branchlines, and attach to
the M81 igniters with M81 safety pins facing the same direction.
コ Step 3. Tape an M11, M12, M13, M21, or M23 every 18 inches to improve efficiency.
コ Step 4. Tape an 18- to 24-inch length of detonating cord to the M11, M12, M13, M21, or M23
blast caps so they overlap and the detonating cord forms a loop.
BREACHERS BRIEF
7-80. All elements of the brief should be covered. The following format should be used:
コ Primary target. Give a full description of the primary target or targets if a multiple breaches are
planned. Discuss the target type (such as the door or window) and where the target is located in
relation to the position and the surrounding area.
コ Alternate target. Determine if there is an alternate target. Determine what will be the alternate
target if the primary target cannot be accessed. Be sure to describe this target in detail, by type,
the location, and surrounding hazards. Explain where it is located in relation to the primary
target, distance, direction, and method of approach.
コ Charges, tools, or techniques for each target. Tell what charges will be used (primary charge,
alternate charge, and all interior charges). Explain what mechanical tools will be used in
attacking the target and how to use them, and explain how to backup the explosive charge. Go
into the specifics of how the charges will be employed and how the mechanical tools will be
employed as a back up. Explain the detonation system. Explain what initiation type will be used
with each charge (shock tube, time fuse, electric, and so forth). Describe what signal or notice
will be used to let everyone know the charge is to be fired. Tell if the shot will go on the signal
or if there will be a delay and whether they will hear the delay (pop or bang).
コ Net explosive weight. Give the NEW and the MSD for each charge to be used. At a minimum,
ensure that the MSD standoff is given.
Note. Certain situations in an urban environment may warrant the assault team to position
themselves closer to the breach. In this situation, tell the assault unit the MSD they can be from
the breach and why.
コ Location of equipment within the team. Tell who is to carry what equipment and where that
individual is in the element. Describe the primary and alternate charges and any other equipment
that will or may be used in the breaching operations.
コ Location of the breacher and assistants. Tell the unit where you will be during the different
phases of the assault. (They may have to assist you or pick up the breach if you become injured.)
Tell them where you will be in the formation during—
ト The movement to the target. Ensure that everyone knows where in the formation the
breacher will be if movement to the target is necessary.
ト The charge placement. Explain where the breacher and assistant will be when placing the
charge and how the charge will be placed.
ト Firing. Determine where the breacher and the assistant will be when the charge is fired.
ト The assault. Determine where the breacher and the assistant will be when the actual assault
is being conducted.
コ Charge placement and attack point. Discuss where and how the charge will be placed on the
target. (This area complements the information given, such as where the personnel will be during
charge placement in case someone has to assist you.) Ensure that the specifics are discussed of
who will do what during the placement (such as who holds the shock tube, who places the
charge, who controls the firing device, and who pays out and secures the firing system).
コ Conditions expected during the breach. Explain exactly what will happen when the breach
charge is fired. Ensure that the noise, fire, smoke, and any other effects that will result during the
firing of the breach are explained. Explain the firing sequence and if there will only be one noise
or multiple noises.
Note. The more the team knows what to expect, the better prepared they are to react.
コ Post blast conditions. Explain the conditions in the area of the breach that the team members
can expect to encounter when they reach the breach site (such as dense smoke, fiberglass dust, or
grease). Emphasize the fragmentation hazards and how long to wait before they expose
themselves to the breach point. Determine what the breach point will look like, where it will be,
where the plug will be, and what should the team members look out for (such as the plug or a
swinging door). Explain what type of damage will have occurred to the structure and will any
other attack method be required before entering the building (such as a rake or break).
Note. The more they know, the better they can react.
コ Abort or alternate the breach signal. Explain the communications plan and the signals needed
to put an abort or a move to the alternate breach into effect. Discuss who will signal the abort or
alternate and what the criteria will be to put a call for these plans into effect.
コ Misfire procedures. Discuss what needs to be done if the charge dies and does not detonate.
Explain to the team the procedures for reattaching an initiation system, if necessary. Explain
who in the team will carry a backup system.
コ Compromise procedures. Discuss what the team should do to secure the charges in case the
team is compromised. Explain that the assault leader will make the final decision on the
compromise reaction; however, as the breacher you must suggest what actions are to be taken in
reference to the breach team.
コ Breacher casualty procedures. Designate who will take over in the event that you are a
casualty. Be sure to cover where each team member carrying a charge is to carry it. (Should a
member go down, the designated replacement must be able to recover the charge without a
search.) Ensure that each replacement knows what to do in the event he becomes the breacher
(determine who will take over, determine who will take over if the assistant is a casualty, and
determine the necessary security measures).
コ Actions upon encountering booby traps and improvised explosive devices. Brief the team on
these actions. Ensure that each member of the team understands that he MUST be on the lookout
for booby traps and improvised explosive devices (IEDs). Review the unit SOP of the assault
team in case there are major differences in how they are handled.
Note. As the breacher, you will likely be the first one to encounter booby traps.
コ Any other pertinent information. Brief anything that is important for the team to know and
that could not logically be fit anywhere else in the sequence.
detonation of the charge at the breach site. Emphasize on the firing sequence and if there will be
one blast or multiple blasts. The more the team knows of what to expect, the better prepared the
team will be and will be able to react quickly.
コ Failed breach. Discuss the method of entry should the charge fail to provide the opening
planned for at this point of the brief. This gives the mechanical breacher time to react with the
tools that may be needed to create the entry point and continue the mission.
コ Breachers casualty procedures. Determine who will take over in the event that the breacher
becomes a casualty. Be sure to cover whom is carrying the charges where they will carry them.
Note. Should a team member go down, a designated replacement must be able to recover the
charge and complete the mission. This ensures that all team members are able to conduct the
other person’s job.
7-82. Regardless of the breaching method used to lead the assault, the breacher sets the pace for the entire
element. The breacher team should be given as much information as possible about the breach, even if it is
only a hasty brief. The information will give the entire team the confidence and will enhance the chances of
a successful breach.
TIMBER-CUTTING FORMULAS
B-2. The following formulas are examples of charge calculations converted to their metric equivalents.
コ Tamped internal charges.
D2
K =
3,500
where—
D2
K=
560
where—
コ Abatis charges.
D2
K=
700
where—
STEEL-CUTTING FORMULAS
B-3. Table B-2 gives the correct metric weight of TNT necessary to cut structural-steel sections of various
dimensions. To find the correct metric weight, use the following formulas or Table B-2:
コ Structural steel.
A
K=
38
where—
コ Other steel.
D2
K=
14
where—
Note. Measure H and T to the nearest 0.1 meter, but no less than 0.3 meter. Minimum tamping
required is 30 centimeters. Increase K by one-third for untamped charges.
BREACHING CHARGES
B-5. See Table B-3, page B-4. The following formula is used to determine the metric size of breaching
charges:
K = R3MC
where—
K = TNT required (in kilograms)
R = breaching radius (in meters) (Chapter 3)
M = material factor (Table B-3)
C = tamping factor (Figure 3-15, page 3-19)
BREACHING RADIUS
B-6. The breaching radius is the distance a charge must penetrate to displace or destroy the target. For
example, to determine the breaching radius for a 2.9-meter concrete wall with a charge placed on its side,
use 3.0 as the breaching radius in the formula above. Always round the depth of the target to the next
higher quarter meter (2.9 becomes 3.0, 2.54 becomes 2.75, and so forth).
MATERIAL FACTOR
B-7. See Table B-3. Table B-3 lists the material factors for breaching charges.
TAMPING FACTOR
B-8. The value of the tamping factor depends on the location and tamping of the charge. A charge is not
adequately tamped unless the depth of the tamping material equals or exceeds the breaching radius.
Figure 3-15, page 3-19, gives values for the tamping factors.
SOURCES
C-1. Primary and supplementary charges are the two types of charges used. The paragraphs below
describe their use.
PRIMARY CHARGES
C-2. Primary charges are obtained from captured or friendly supply stocks or, in the case of landmines,
recovered from enemy or friendly minefields. Unexploded duds (shells or bombs) should never be used for
demolition purposes.
SUPPLEMENTARY CHARGES
C-3. When necessary, allied nation or captured explosives to supplement or replace standard explosive
charges can be used
LANDMINES
C-4. The paragraphs below describe the safety precautions that need to be used when dealing with
landmines. Also described are charge calculations and landmine priming.
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
C-5. Only use defused mines as demolition charges. Recovered mines may be sensitive because of near
misses and may detonate during normal handling. The theater commander prescribes the policy for using
salvaged or captured threat mines.
CHARGES
C-6. When calculating charges using mines, only the explosive weight is considered. Generally, use
normal explosive quantities for cratering or pressure charges. The mine case does not allow proper contact
of the explosives against irregularly shaped objects; therefore, it may be necessary to increase the size of
the cutting charges considerably when using mines for this purpose. Test shots are the best way to
determine the proper charge under given conditions. Table C-1, page C-2, lists the explosives content of
various AT mines by country of origin. U.S. mines are current; foreign mines may be current or obsolete.
PRIMING
C-7. A landmine can be detonated by placing a 1-pound charge as close to the mine as possible without
touching the mine. If firing large quantities of mines simultaneously, prime several mines to ensure
complete detonation. Detonating a single mine normally detonates any other mine in direct contact with the
primed mine.
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
C-9. The shape of an aerial bomb makes it inefficient for demolitions requiring close contact between the
explosive and the target. Precautions should be taken against fragmentation, because the steel fragments
from bomb cases may fly great distances. Before using any bomb, it should be positively identified it as a
GP bomb.
CHARGES
C-10. The explosive content of an aerial bomb is about half its total weight. Table C-2 lists the explosives
content for various GP bombs. About 20 percent of the explosive potential of an aerial bomb is expended in
shattering the casing.
PRIMING
C-11. Bombs less than 500 pounds are detonated by placing a 5-pound explosive charge on the middle of
the casing; bombs exceeding 500 pounds require a 10-pound charge. Fuses should not be placed on the
nose or tail of the bomb. To ensure detonation, prime large bombs separately.
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
C-13. Artillery shells have a low-explosive content. They are generally not adequate for other demolition
purposes.
CHARGES
C-14. Shells smaller than 100 millimeters should be avoided. The 105-millimeter, howitzer, HE shell that
weighs 33 pounds, and contains only 5 pounds of explosive. The 155-millimeter howitzer shell contains
only 15 pounds of explosive.
FOREIGN EXPLOSIVES
DANGER
Ensure that positive identification of the ordnance item filler is
made before use in demolition operations or disposal of
munitions. Munitions can contain a variety of hazardous fillers
other than HE. Failure to comply may cause death or permanent
injury.
C-16. Foreign explosives are used to supplement standard U.S. charges. In certain cases, they are used
instead of U.S. charges.
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
C-17. Only experienced demolition personnel should work with foreign explosives and then only according
to instructions and directives issued by the theater commander. TM 9-1300-214 lists the most common
foreign explosives.
PRIMING
C-18. Most foreign-explosive blocks have cap wells large enough to receive U.S. military blasting caps.
However, test fire these charges with U.S. military blasting caps to ensure positive detonation. In certain
instances, you may have to initiate the explosives by using a standard U.S. demolition block primed with a
blasting cap.
SHAPED CHARGE
D-1. Shaped charges concentrate the energy of the explosion released on a small area, making a tubular or
linear fracture in the target. The versatility and simplicity of shaped charges make them effective against
many targets, especially those made of concrete or with armor plating.
DESCRIPTION
D-2. A shaped charge (Figure D-1) can be improvised. Because of the many variables (configuration,
explosive density, linear cavity density, and so forth), consistent results are impossible to obtain. Therefore,
experiment to determine the optimum standoff distances. Plastic explosive is best suited for this charge
type. However, dynamite and molten TNT can be effective expedients.
FABRICATION
D-3. For a shaped charge, a container should be obtained. Both ends of the container should be removed.
Almost any kind of container will work (cans, jars, bottles, or drinking glasses). Some containers come
equipped with built-in cavity liners, such as champagne or cognac bottles with the stems removed. With the
ends removed, the container is ready for a cavity liner and explosive. Optimum shaped-charge
characteristics include the following:
コ Cavity liner. A cone-shaped cavity liner should be made for the container from copper, tin, zinc,
or glass. Funnels or bottles with a cone in the bottom (champagne or cognac bottles) are
excellent. However, if material is not available for a cavity liner, make a workable, but less
effective shaped charge by cutting a cone-shaped cavity in a block of explosive.
コ Cavity angle. For most high-explosive antitank (HEAT) ammunition, the cavity angle is 42° to
45°. Expedient charges will work with cavity angles between 30° and 60°.
コ Explosive height (in the container). The explosive height is two times the cone height,
measured from the base of the cone to the top of the explosive. Being careful not to alter the
cavity angle of the cone, press the explosive into the container. The explosive should be tightly
packed and free of any air pockets.
コ Standoff distance. The normal standoff distance is 1 1/2 the diameter of the cone. Standoff
sticks are used to achieve this.
コ Detonation point. The exact top center of the charge is the detonation point. If any part of the
blasting cap is exposed or extends above the charge, cover the blasting cap with a small quantity
of composition C4.
Note. Remove the narrow neck of a bottle or the stem of a glass by wrapping it with a piece of
soft, absorbent twine or by soaking the string in gasoline and lighting it. Place two bands of
adhesive tape, one on each side of the twine, to hold the twine firmly in place. Turn the bottle or
stem continuously with the neck up to heat the glass uniformly. Submerge the neck of the bottle
in water, and tap it against some object to break it off after the twine or plastic has burned. Tape
the sharp edge of the bottle to prevent cutting your hands while tamping the explosive in place.
A narrow band of plastic explosive placed around the neck of the bottle and burned, gives the
same results as string or twine. Do not immerse the bottle in water before the plastic explosive
has completely burned, or it may detonate.
PLATTER CHARGE
D-4. The platter charge uses the Miznay-Shardin effect. It turns a metal plate into a powerful, blunt-nosed
projectile (Figure D-2). The platter charge can be used in situations requiring shaped charges or as a
penetrator for demolition missions. If available, use a round, steel platter. However, a square platter will
also work.
CHARGE SIZE
D-5. A quantity of explosive equal to the weight of the platter should be used. The platter should weigh 2
to 6 pounds.
FABRICATION
D-6. The explosive should be uniformly packed behind the platter. A container is not necessary if the
explosive will remain firmly against the platter without a container. Tape is an acceptable anchoring
material. At the rear center, prime the charge. If any part of the blasting cap is exposed, cover the blasting
cap with a small quantity of composition C4.
D-7. If available, use a gutted M60 fuse igniter as an expedient aiming device, and aim the charge at the
direct center of a target. The explosive should be on the side of the platter opposite the target. With
practice, a 55-gallon drum or a relatively small target can be hit at 25 yards about 90 percent of the time
with a platter charge.
GRAPESHOT CHARGE
D-8. The grapeshot charge consists of a container (an ammunition can or a number 10 can), projectiles
(nails, bolts, small pieces of scrap metal, or rocks), buffer material (soil, leaves, felt, cloth, cardboard, or
wood), a charge (plastic explosive like composition C4), and a blasting cap or detonating cord. This charge
should be used when conventional claymore-type firing devices are not available. Assemble these
components as shown in Figure D-3. A quantity of explosive equal to 1/4 the projectile weight should be
used.
Note. The United Nations Convention on Certain Conventional Weapons (CCW) mandates that
all fragment munitions produce fragments that are visible by an X ray (such as metal or rock).
D-9. In the center of the bottom of the container, make a hole large enough to accept a blasting cap or a
detonating cord knot. The components are placed in the container as follows:
コ Step 1. Explosive. Place the plastic explosive uniformly in the bottom of the container. Remove
all voids or air spaces by pressing the composition C4 into the container using a nonsparking
instrument.
コ Step 2. Buffer. Place 2 inches of buffer material directly on top of the explosive.
コ Step 3. Projectiles. Place the projectiles on top of the buffer material. Place a covering over the
projectiles to prevent them from spilling out when handling the charge.
D-10. In the plastic explosive charge, make a cap well through the hole in the bottom of the container, and
insert the blasting cap of the initiating set. If any part of the blasting cap is exposed, cover it with a small
quantity of composition C4. From about 100 feet, aim the charge at the center of the target.
DUST-INITIATOR CHARGE
D-11. Dust-initiator charges use small quantities of explosives with larger amounts of powdered materials
(dust or cover) to destroy thin-walled, wooden buildings or railroad boxcars. These charges work best in an
enclosed area with few windows. At detonation, the dust or cover is distributed in the air within the target
and ignited by an explosive-incendiary charge. The dust-initiator charge consists of an explosive (mixed
with equal parts of incendiary mix) and a cover of finely divided organic material. The charge can be
detonated by attaching initiating sets to the detonating cord.
CHARGE COMPUTATIONS
D-12. The charges and cover size for the charge computations are as follows:
コ Charge size. One pound of explosive-incendiary mixture will effectively detonate up to
40 pounds of cover. To make a 1-pound explosive-incendiary mixture, combine 1/2 pound of
crushed TNT or composition C3 and 1/2 pound of incendiary mix (two parts of aluminum
powder or magnesium powder and three parts of ferric oxide). Do not use composition C4,
because the explosive component in composition C4 will not combine properly with the
incendiary mixture.
コ Cover (dust) size. Use 3 to 5 pounds of cover for each 1,000 cubic feet of target (3 pounds for
enclosed buildings, and 5 pounds for partially enclosed buildings). The cover can consist of coal
dust, cocoa, powdered coffee, confectioners’ sugar, tapioca, wheat flour, cornstarch, hard rubber
dust, aluminum powder, magnesium powder, powdered soap, or a volatile fuel, such as gasoline.
FABRICATION
D-13. The TNT explosive is placed in a canvas bag and crushed into a powder with a wooden mallet. In the
same bag that contains the crushed explosive, an equal amount of incendiary mixture is added and mixed
thoroughly. This explosive incendiary charge is primed with a detonating cord knot. The primed charge is
placed in the center of the target. The cover is then poured or placed on top of the primed charge to form a
pyramid. When using gasoline as the cover, no more than 3 gallons should be used, since greater quantities
will not evenly disperse in the air and will give poor results.
Note. Boreholes should receive 10 pounds of explosives for every foot of depth and must be
dual-primed.
Note. According to the rule of thumb, a hole 10 inches in diameter holds 10 strands of
detonating cord.
コ Place the detonating cord wick into the hole using an inserting rod or some other field expedient.
Ensure that the strands are extended the full length of the hole.
コ Fire the cord either electrically or nonelectrically. Fire an unlimited number of wicks at one time
by connecting them with the detonating cord ring main or line main. Blow out excess gases and
inspect the hole for excessive heat if placing successive charges in the holes.
PREPARATION
D-17. The following steps are used to prepare a ammonium-nitrate satchel charge:
コ Step 1. Melt the wax in a container.
コ Step 2. Stir in the ammonium-nitrate pellets, ensuring that the wax is hot while mixing. Before
the mixture hardens, add a 1/2-pound block of explosive primed with detonating cord.
コ Step 3. Ensure that the primed charge is in the center of the mixture and that there is enough
detonating cord available to attach the initiating sets.
コ Step 4. Pour the mixture into a container. Add shrapnel material to the mixture, if desired, or
attach on the outside of the container to give a shrapnel effect.
コ Step 5. Detonate the charge by attaching initiating sets to the detonating cord coming from the
satchel charge.
USE
D-18. Because the wax and fertilizer may be molded into almost any size or shape, it may be applied to a
large number of demolition projects with satisfactory results.
PREPARATION
D-20. The following steps are used to prepare a flame fougasse:
コ Step 1. Make the fougasse mixture by mixing 3 ounces of M4 thickening compound per gallon
of gasoline or jet petroleum 8 fuel.
Note. Depending on the temperature, the mixture may take from 15 minutes to several hours to
thicken to the desired viscosity (resembling applesauce or runny gelatin). For a 55-gallon drum,
vigorously mix 150 ounces of M4 thickening compound with 50 gallons of gasoline or JP 8 fuel.
コ Step 2. Dig an angled trench for the 55-gallon drum that will allow the best coverage and
dispersion of the flame fougasse. Do not build the trench steeper than 45°. Make a small cutout
area in the back of the trench for the kicker charge (2 pounds of TNT or 1 block of composition
C4).
コ Step 3. Prime the kicker charge with detonating cord, leaving 6 to 10 feet of detonating cord free
to tie into a ring main.
コ Step 4. Wrap the top end of the 55-gallon drum with 5 to 7 wraps of detonating cord, leaving 6
to 10 feet of the detonating cord free to tie into a ring main.
コ Step 5. Lay the drum in the trench, and place the kicker charge in the small cutout. Push the
drum against the back of the trench so that the kicker charge seats firmly against the bottom of
the drum. (It may be necessary to tamp the soil around the charge to center the kicker charge
properly against the bottom of the drum.) Ensure that the running ends of detonating cord for the
kicker charge and drum top extend from the trench. Avoid kinks or sharp bends in the detonating
cord.
コ Step 6. Lay out a ring main of detonating cord around the 55-gallon drum, and tie the detonating
cord from the kicker charge and wraps to the ring main.
コ Step 7. Cover the entire 55-gallon drum with a minimum of 3 feet of tamped soil, leaving the
front of the drum exposed or uncovered.
コ Step 8. Use a length of detonating cord and tape one end under the spoon handle of an igniter
trip flare (M49). Tape the spoon handle down securely, attach the trip flare to a stake, and
position the stake 3 to 4 feet in front of the drum. Attach the free end of the detonating cord that
is secured to the trip flare to the ring main. During combat, a white phosphorous (WP) grenade
(M34) will work in place of the trip flare. Do the following if trip flares are not available:
ト Take a 2-liter plastic bottle, and fill it half full with raw gasoline or JP 8 (unthickened).
ト Punch a hole in the cap of the bottle. Thread one end of a detonating cord through the hole.
ト Tie a single overhand knot in the detonating cord to prevent it from being pulled back out
of the cap.
ト Place the detonating cord with the single overhand knot inside the bottle. Secure the cap
onto the bottle.
ト Take the opposite end of the detonating cord, and attach it to the ring main.
コ Step 9. Attach initiating sets to the ring main or junction box.
FUNCTION
D-21. When initiated, the ring main initiates the detonating cord to the trip flare, the drum top, and the
kicker charge. The wraps cut the top of the drum off, the kicker charge propels the thickened fuel outward,
and the trip flare ignites the thickened fuel as it travels downrange. The result is a flash of flame that
spreads downrange for about 100 meters.
Step 1
Step 2
Step 3
SCANMAN KNOT
D-25. The scanman knot (Figure D-7) is a detonating cord knot tied at the end of a branchline to connect
the branchline to a firing system. The scanman knot saves time on a target when tied before arriving at the
mission site. This knot does not take the place of the girth hitch with an extra turn or detonating cord clips.
OHM’S LAW
E-1. Ohm’s law defines the amount of voltage necessary to detonate the blasting caps. The required
voltage for a firing circuit is determined as follows:
E = IR
where—
E = electric potential or voltage (in volts)
I = current (in amperes)
R = resistance (in ohms)
ELECTRIC-POWER FORMULA
E-2. The amount of electric power (watts) necessary to detonate blasting caps is determined as follows:
W = I2R
where—
W = electrical power (in watts)
I = current (in amperes)
R = resistance (in ohms)
CIRCUIT RESISTANCE
E-4. The power source should be adequate to fire all charges connected to the circuit. Firing wire and
blasting caps contribute to the total resistance in the circuit. The amount of resistance is determined by
combining the individual resistances of the blasting caps and wires. The resistance of the wire depends on
the size and length of the wire. Table E-1, page E-2, gives the resistance per 1,000 foot of various sizes of
copper wire.
Wire Characteristics
Note. Number 18 wire consists of two strands. The example specifies a 500-foot piece of wire,
so use 1,000 feet as the total wire length for determining resistance (500 x 2 = 1,000).
VOLTAGE DROP
E-7. Ohm’s law allows you to determine the amount of voltage required (voltage drop) for a blasting
circuit. In practice, the voltage drop should never exceed 90 percent of the available voltage. If it does,
decrease the resistance or increase the voltage in the circuit to ensure that proper detonation occurs.
BLASTING MACHINES
E-8. The nameplate on power sources normally states the amperage and the voltage ratings. Before using
any power source, determine whether it is suitable for the firing circuit. Generally, determine the adequacy
of a power source by consulting Table E-2. This table lists the sizes of circuits that power sources can
support. The capabilities of the power source must be determined from the nameplate. The following steps
are followed:
コ Step 1. Multiply the voltage rating of the power source by 90 percent to get an adjusted voltage
rating.
コ Step 2. Divide the adjusted voltage rating by the amperage rating (1.5 amperes) of the circuit.
Note. At this point, you have the maximum allowable resistance in the circuit in ohms.
コ Step 3. Determine the total resistance of the firing wire (Table E-1).
コ Step 4. Subtract the resistance of the wire from the maximum allowable circuit resistance
(step 2) to determine the maximum allowable resistance of the blasting caps in the circuit.
コ Step 5. Determine the maximum number of blasting caps the circuit will support by dividing the
allowable resistance for caps (step 4) by the resistance in one cap (2 ohms).
E-9. The maximum number of electric blasting caps allowed in a series circuit fired by a 220-volt,
13.5-ampere generator and 250 feet of double-strand, 20-gauge wire (a total of 500 feet of wire) is
determined as follows:
コ Maximum allowable resistance (paragraph E-8, steps 1 and 2).
126.9 ohms
= 63.45 caps (round down to 63 caps)
2 ohms
CHARGE CALCULATIONS
Problem. Using the internal timber cutting charge, determine the quantity of composition C4 required to cut a
30-inch diameter tree.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
D = 30 inches
Calculate the TNT or use the rule of thumb.
D2 30 2 900
Step 2 P= = = = 3.6 pounds of TNT
250 250 250
Note. P = .004D2
Divide by the RE factor, if required.
Step 3 P 3.6
= = 2.68 pounds of composition C4
RE 1.34
Divide by the package weight or volume, and round UP to the next whole package.
Step 4 P 2.68
= = 2.14, round up to 3 packages of compositio n C4
Package weight 1.25
Calculate the number of charges.
Step 5
One tree = One charge
Note. You must split the charge between the two boreholes because the tree is larger than 18 inches in diameter. See
Chapter 3, Section II.
Calculate the total amount of explosives.
Step 6
Step 4 x Step 5 = Total packages = 3 x 1 = 3 packages of composition C4
Solution. To cut a 30-inch diameter tree using an internal timber-cutting charge, three packages of
composition C4 is needed and is placed in two boreholes. See Figure 3-2, page 3-5, for charge placement.
Problem. Using the external timber cutting charge formula, determine the quantity of TNT required to cut a
30-inch diameter tree.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
D = 30 inches
Calculate the TNT or use the rule of thumb.
2 2
Step 2 D 30 900
P= = = = 22.5 pounds of TNT
40 40 40
2
Note. P = .025D
Divide by the RE factor, if required.
Step 3 P 22.5
= = 22.5 pounds of TNT
RE 1
Divide by package weight or volume, and round UP to the next whole package.
Step 4 P 22.5
= = 22.5 packages of TNT; round up to 23 packages of TNT
Package weight 1
Calculate the number of charges.
Step 5
One tree = One charge
Calculate the total amount of explosives.
Step 6
Step 4 x Step 5 = Total packages = 23 x 1 = 23 packages of TNT
Solution. To cut a 30-inch diameter tree using an external timber charge, 23 packages of TNT is needed. See
Figure 3-3, page 3-6, for charge placement.
3
Problem. Using the steel-cutting charge formula, P = A , determine the quantity of composition C4 required
8
to cut the two steel beams shown below.
3 3
P= A = x 62 = 23.25 pounds of TNT
8 8
Note. P = 0.375A
Divide by the RE factor, if required.
Step 3 23.25
= 17.35 pounds of composition C4
1.34
Divide by the package weight or volume, and round UP to the next whole package.
Step 4 17.35
= 13.8; round up to14 packages of composition C4
1.25
Calculate the number of charges.
Step 5
Two beams = Two charges
Calculate the total amount of explosives.
Step 6
Step 4 x Step 5 = Total packages = 14 x 2 = 28 packages of composition C4
Solution. To cut the two beams, 28 packages of composition C4 is needed. See Figure 3-7, page 3-10, for
charge placement.
Problem. Using the hasty, steel-cutting formula and Table 3-4, page 3-12, determine the quantity of
composition C4 required to cut the steel beam shown below.
Problem. Using the steel-cutting charge calculation (steel plate), determine the quantity of composition C4
required to cut the steel plate shown below using a ribbon charge.
Problem. Using the steel-cutting charge calculation (I beam), determine the quantity of composition C4
required to cut the I beam shown below using a ribbon charge.
Step 2
Problem. Using the steel-cutting charge calculation (steel bar), determine the quantity of composition C4
required to cut a 7-inch steel bar using a saddle charge.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
a. Target diameter = 7 inches
b. Target circumference = 3.14 x 7 = 21.98 inches
Calculate the TNT or use the rule of thumb.
Problem. Using the steel-cutting charge calculation (high-carbon steel), determine the quantity of composition
C4 required to cut an 8-inch, high-carbon, steel bar using a diamond charge.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
a. Target diameter: 8 inches
b. Target circumference: 3.14 x 8 = 25.12 inches
Determine the required charge dimensions.
Problem. Using the formula R3KC, determine the number of composition C4 packages required to breach a
reinforced-concrete pier, 5 feet thick and 30 feet wide. The charges will be elevated 5 feet and untamped.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
a. Breaching radius (R): 5 feet
b. Pier width (W): 30 feet
Calculate the TNT or use the rule of thumb.
Step 2
P = R3KC = 53(0.63)1.8 = 141.75 pounds of TNT
Divide by the RE factor, if required.
Step 3 141.75
= 105.78 pounds of composition C4
1.34
Divide by the package weight or volume, and round UP to the next whole package.
Step 5 W 30
N= = = 3 charges
2R 2(5)
Calculate the total amount of explosives.
Step 6
Step 4 x Step 5 = Total packages = 85 x 3 = 255 packages of composition C4
Solution. To breach the pier, 255 packages of composition C4 are needed. See Figure 3-16, page 3-22, for
charge placement.
Problem. Using the counterforce charge calculation, determine the required amount of composition C4
needed to counterforce four concrete cubes 3 feet thick.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
Target thickness = 3 feet
Calculate the TNT or use the rule of thumb.
Step 2
P = 1 1/2 pounds of composition C4 per foot of diameter
P = 1 1/2 x 3 = 4.5 pounds of composition C4
Divide by the RE factor, if required.
Step 3
Not required because only composition C4 or sheet explosives are used.
Divide by the package weight or volume, and round UP to the next whole package.
Problem. Using the cratering charge calculation, determine the quantity of cratering charges and composition
C4 required to create a deliberate crater 146 feet long.
Obtain the critical dimensions.
Step 1
Crater length (L) = 146 feet
Calculate the TNT or use the rule of thumb.
Step 2
a. 7-foot borehole = 80 pounds of explosive
b. 5-foot borehole = 40 pounds of explosive
Divide by the RE factor, if required.
Step 3
Not required.
Divide by the package weight or volume, and round UP to the next whole package.
Step 4
a. 7-foot borehole = 2 cratering charges and 2 packages of composition C4
b. 5-foot borehole = 1 cratering charge and 2 packages of composition C4
Calculate the number of charges.
Step 5 L - 16 146 - 16
N= +1 = + 1 = 27 holes
5 5
27/2 = 13.5; round up to 14 for 7-foot holes and round down to 13 for 5-foot holes
Calculate the total amount of explosives.
DEMOLITION CALCULATIONS
Problem. Using a concrete-stripping charge to destroy a simply supported, concrete-deck, top-support bridge
span. The diagram below shows the span dimensions (determine the quantity of composition C4 required).
Beam Calculations
Determine the amount of TNT required per meter.
Step 1
P = (3.3h + 0.5)3 3.3 = [3.3(1.2) + 0.5]3 3.33 = 295.42606488 pounds of TNT per meter
Determine the amount of explosive (TNT) per beam.
Step 2
P = (pounds TNT/meter) (bridge width, in meters)
P = 295.42606488 = 3545.11277856 pounds of TNT
Determine the equivalent amount of composition C4.
Step 3 P 3545.11277856
= = 2645.606551 pounds of composition C4
RE 1.34
Determine the required packages of composition C4 per beam.
ATTACK DEMOLITIONS
Problem. Using a bottom-attack bridge calculation, determine the attack method for demolishing a simply
supported, steel-beam deck bridge with bottom supports and the following measurements:
a. Length (L): 25 meters
b. Height (H): 2.1 meters
c. End clearance (E): 0.4 meters
Refer to Appendix H. Table H-1, page H-1, lists the bottom attack method for this bridge,
Step 1
provided that the actual end clearance (E) is greater than ER.
Perform the calculation to determine whether E is greater than ER.
H 2.1
= = 0.084
L 25
Step 2
b. Find the corresponding E/L value (Table H-1). Since 0.084 is not found on the table, go to
the next higher value, 0.09.
c. From the higher value, 0.09, move directly below, and find value 0.0160.
d. Determine the required end clearance. Find ER as follows:
Problem. Using the top-attack bridge calculation, determine the attack method for demolishing a simply
supported, bowstring bridge with the following measurements.
a. Length (L): 62 meters
b. Height (H): 8.5 meters
c. Average length of bearing supports (LS): 1.15 meters
Step 1 Refer to Appendix H. Table H-2, page H-2, lists the top-attack method for this bridge.
Determine the height-to-length ratio (H/L).
H 8.5
Step 2 = = 0.137
L 62
LC/L = 0.082
Step 5
b. Multiply the LC/L value by the length to get LC.
Problem. Using the arch-bridge attack calculation, determine the attack method for a continuous, concrete-
arch bridge with open spandrels and pinned footings, having the following measurements:
a. Length (L): 58 meters
b. Rise (H): 7.5 meters
Refer to Appendix H. Table H-4, pages H-4 through H-8, lists the bridge-attack method for this
Step 1
bridge.
Determine the height-to-length ratio (H/L):
Step 2 H 7.5
= = 0.129
L 58
Find the corresponding LC/L value (Table H-3, page H-3).
Step 3
Since 0.129 is not found on the table, round UP to 0.14. The value found below 0.14 is 0.04.
Determine the required length of the cut.
Step 4 LC
LC = (L) = (0.04) 58 = 2.32 meters
L
Step 5 Determine where to place the charges. Place the charges at the midspan.
Solution. The proposed cut must be at the midspan. Mark the bridge in this location. This location is the
centerline for the proposed cut.
HARBOR CLEARANCE
G-1. A harbor may be blocked deliberately to deny its use to an enemy or as a result of bombardment. In
one case, ships and other objects will be positioned and sunk in locations to make harbor clearance
difficult. In another case, obstruction will be haphazard. When harbors are blocked intentionally, it is
possible that explosives have been placed as hazards for harbor clearance personnel. When harbors are
obstructed as a result of bombardment, there may be explosives in sunken ships or scattered on the harbor
bottom.
DANGER
The rendering safe of underwater explosive ordnance is outside
the scope of salvage operations. Whenever the presence of
explosives is known or suspected, Navy EOD personnel should
clear the area before salvage operations begin. Failure to comply
may cause death or permanent injury.
SHIP SALVAGE
G-2. Before salvage operations begin, determine whether sunken ships are to be dispersed by explosives,
converted to mooring or docking facilities, or salvaged for reuse or scrap. The condition of a sunken ship
and the need for it may dictate that the ship be salvaged for reuse. The need for scrap steel and the
availability of outgoing supply channels may make salvage for scrap the prime consideration. On the other
hand, the immediate tactical need for the harbor may make it imperative that all sunken ships be dispersed
or flattened so the harbor will be cleared in the minimum time.
G-3. Unsalvageable vessels and other equipment can be marked and left in place, sectioned and removed,
flattened, dispersed, or settled with explosives. Whether a particular ship is dispersed completely in one
continuous operation is determined by the overall situation at the site. If a well-blocked harbor is made
usable first for shallow-draft vessels and then for deeper-draft ships, the upper portions of several obstacles
are dispersed and followed by progressive demolition of the lower portions of the same obstacles. If a
single sunken ship blocks a channel, the entire ship may be dispersed in a single operation. Depending on
the particular situation, sectioning, flattening, dispersal, and settlement methods can be used.
SECTIONING
G-4. Sectioning involves cutting the vessel into manageable pieces. It also involves removing the pieces to
designated locations.
FLATTENING
G-5. Flattening uses explosives to first remove the superstructure and then crushes the hull to the bottom.
The stages in which a ship is flattened will depend on the position of the ship with respect to the bottom. A
ship resting on its side presents a different problem from one that is sitting upright on the bottom. In most
cases, the masts and rigging are removed first, then the superstructure is removed or dispersed, and finally
the hull itself is flattened. In all hull-flattening operations, charges are placed to take advantage of the
weight of and existing stresses in structural members. The greater the stress on the member, the less
explosive needed to cut or break it.
DISPERSAL
G-6. The time limitation in the emergency clearing of a harbor or channel usually does not permit the
salvage of a sunken ship, either by raising or by cutting it up for scrap. When time is essential, dispersal of
the sunken ship by demolition is the most effective way of clearing the harbor or channel. The hull is
dispersed by placing heavy demolition charges inside each end of the hull and one heavy charge in the
center. Detonation of the charges is simultaneous. Usually the heavy planking or frames take most of the
ribs and frames with it, forcing the hull outward by the explosion. Ribs or frames left standing must be cut
individually.
SETTLEMENT
G-7. Explosives can be used to prevent the ship from settling on the bottom. Explosives can also be used
to make the ship settle farther on the bottom.
コ Prevention. When a ship is to be salvaged, the bottom can be compacted beneath it to prevent
further settling. This is done by driving detonating powder points into the bottom around the
hull. For this purpose, the powder points should be loaded with an explosive with a low rate of
detonation, such as ammonium nitrate. Charges must be light enough so the hull of the ship is
not damaged.
コ Future settlement. When a ship resting on a sandy or muddy bottom is to be dispersed or
flattened, it should be settled as deeply as possible. Settle it by blowing holes in the hull along
the bottom to reduce the bearing surface. This allows the bottom material to ooze into the hull.
Added settling will result from increasing the weight of the ship by filling the voids with sand,
mud, or gravel through an airlift.
Note. Removing large sections of steel may require a surface crane or winch from the supported
unit.
IMPALEMENT BLASTING
G-8. Using explosives to remove an impaling point is a slow process. Extra caution should be used when
blasting rock or coral that is in contact with the hull of a watercraft. This will avoid driving the rock further
into the hull or inflicting shock wave damage on the ship. The only procedure feasible under such
circumstances is to begin with very small charges per shot. After each blast, the results are checked and
either the charge size is increased or the step is repeated by using the same size charge. Efforts to speed the
process are likely to cause additional damage. Engineer divers are trained to use special procedures and
techniques and are equipped to perform impalement-blasting operations.
WARNING
As always, even when concrete is being used, treat initial shots
as tests rather than one-shot solutions. Failure to comply could
result in immediate personal injury or damage to equipment.
G-11. Small charges (about 1/8 to 1/4 pound of explosives) are used initially. To avoid creating a large
shock wave, small charges are used in a delay sequence. This process is continued until the impaling point
is removed.
Note. The ship can then be freed by shattering small portions of the impaling point and breaking
the rock free, about 2 feet outside the hull, with each round of explosives.
コ Using a hydraulic sinker drill to drill a pattern of small boreholes along the planned cut line,
leaving some of the holes uncharged.
Note. Relief holes will vent explosive pressure and increase the shattering effect by decreasing
the lateral burden about the charge.
WARNING
Open doors and cargo hatches to prevent an internal
overpressurization of the hull. A flood control plan is required.
Failure to comply could result in immediate personal injury or
damage to equipment.
POWDER POINTS
G-14. Powder points are constructed by driving or jetting pipes into the bottom of a harbor or channel and
then placing charges of composition C4 in the pipes. Charges are made above-water, then the diver places
them into the pipes. To construct powder points, use the following procedures:
コ Above-water.
ト Prepare the plastic explosive charges.
ト Tie a double overhand knot in detonating cord of sufficient length to lower the charge to the
bottom of the pipe.
コ Underwater.
ト Place the powder point perpendicular to the material to be moved.
ト Drive the powder point to a depth equal to that of the desired grade line, plus the distance
between the points.
ト Mold the knotted detonating cord into the top half of the prepared, plastic-explosive charge,
and place the charge into each pipe. Ensure that alternate points contain different charges so
that the detonation effects will not cancel each other.
ト Join individual charges together by a branchline, and connect them to the ring main. Attach
the ring main to the surface initiating system by using a double main line of detonating
cord.
BOREHOLES
G-15. When powder points cannot be used, place charges in boreholes spaced and staggered the same way
as powder points. Boreholes for powder charges are constructed by digging or by using a hydraulic sinker
drill. When a sinker drill is unavailable or time is limited, use small-shaped charges to blast small-diameter
holes into the rock or hard bottom. Boreholes are enlarged by using additional explosives.
CHANNEL ALTERATION
G-16. Channel alteration is an expanded trenching operation. The convenience of straight channels and
free, open anchorages for ship handling must be sacrificed to speed and the most expedient means of
making the harbor usable. Where a deep channel is necessary, a large amount of blasted bottom material
must be removed with the aid of dredging equipment for ultimate disposal (Figure G-5).
POWDER POINTS
G-17. For constructing powder points, refer to paragraph G-14. The procedure described here is used as the
last procedure for completing underwater procedures (use this procedure for channel alteration only).
G-18. Widen or straighten a channel by placing a light charge along the bottom of the existing channel to
be detonated at the same time as the charges in the side being blasted. This prevents the material blasted
from the side from settling in the existing channel.
BOREHOLES
G-19. Where powder points cannot be used, place charges in boreholes that are spaced and staggered the
same way as powder points. The boreholes for powder charges are constructed by digging or by using a
hydraulic sinker drill. When a sinker drill is unavailable or time is limited, use small-shaped charges to
blast small-diameter holes into the rock or hard bottom. Boreholes are enlarged by using more explosives.
SANDBAR REMOVAL
G-20. When sandbars cover a large area or the depth of the cut makes the use of a water jet to scour away
sand impractical, use demolitions powder points (Figure G-6). Refer to the previous paragraphs for the use
of powder points to trench, tunnel, and alter.
Note. This prevents the rapid burning of the time fuse due to water pressure, which could cause
premature detonation.
コ Attach the DWFA to the support line or the strain relief buoy, then attach the detonating cord to
the blasting caps.
コ Untape the coils of the time fuse, and place them face down into the water to prevent them from
burning through.
Note. Several unconventional knots can be used, such as the Gregory knot and right-angle knot
connection, to attach the detonating cord to the trunk line.
ANCHOR
G-26. The support or strain-relief line is attached with detonating cord to the target or to an anchor as close
to the main charge as possible. This will avoid cap-and-charge separation due to wave action, current, and
so forth.
MARKER BUOY
G-28. An additional marker buoy is attached to the target areas. This bouy is used for relocation when
returning for shot investigation.
H/L 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.10
ER/L 0.0002 0.0008 0.0020 0.0030 0.0050 0.0070 0.0100 0.0130 0.0160 0.0200
H/L 0.11 0.12 0.13 0.14 0.15 0.16 0.17 0.18 0.19 0.20
ER/L 0.0240 0.0290 0.0340 0.0390 0.0440 0.0500 0.0570 0.0630 0.0700 0.0770
where—
Notes.
1. Go UP to the next higher value if the result of H/L is not on the chart exactly as calculated. For example, H/L = 0.076,
use the column headed 0.08. Read down that column to determine ER/L. In this case, ER/L = 0.0130.
2. Multiply the ER/L value determined from the chart by L to get ER.
Ls
----- LC
L ( ) Ratio of Section Removed to Span Length
L
H
---- 0.004 0.006 0.008 0.010 0.012 0.014 0.016 0.018 0.020 0.030 0.040 0.050 0.060 0.080 0.100
L
0.01 0.003 0.003 0.004 0.004 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.006 0.006 0.007 0.009 0.010 0.011 0.013 0.015
0.02 0.005 0.006 0.007 0.008 0.009 0.010 0.011 0.011 0.012 0.015 0.017 0.019 0.022 0.026 0.030
0.03 0.008 0.009 0.011 0.012 0.014 0.015 0.016 0.017 0.018 0.022 0.026 0.029 0.033 0.039 0.045
0.04 0.011 0.013 0.015 0.016 0.018 0.019 0.021 0.022 0.023 0.029 0.034 0.039 0.043 0.052 0.060
0.05 0.013 0.016 0.018 0.020 0.022 0.024 0.026 0.028 0.029 0.036 0.043 0.049 0.054 0.065 0.075
0.06 0.015 0.019 0.022 0.025 0.027 0.029 0.031 0.033 0.035 0.044 0.051 0.058 0.065 0.078 0.090
0.07 0.018 0.022 0.026 0.029 0.031 0.034 0.036 0.039 0.041 0.051 0.060 0.068 0.076 0.091 0.105
0.08 0.021 0.025 0.029 0.033 0.036 0.039 0.042 0.044 0.047 0.058 0.068 0.078 0.087 0.104 0.120
0.09 0.023 0.028 0.033 0.037 0.040 0.044 0.047 0.050 0.053 0.065 0.077 0.087 0.097 0.116 0.135
0.10 0.026 0.032 0.036 0.041 0.045 0.049 0.052 0.055 0.058 0.073 0.085 0.097 0.108 0.129 0.150
0.11 0.028 0.035 0.040 0.045 0.049 0.053 0.057 0.061 0.064 0.080 0.094 0.107 0.119 0.142 0.165
0.12 0.031 0.038 0.044 0.049 0.054 0.058 0.062 0.066 0.070 0.087 0.102 0.116 0.130 0.155 0.180
0.13 0.033 0.041 0.047 0.053 0.058 0.063 0.067 0.072 0.076 0.095 0.111 0.126 0.140 0.168 0.195
0.14 0.036 0.044 0.051 0.057 0.063 0.068 0.073 0.077 0.082 0.102 0.119 0.136 0.151 0.181 0.210
0.15 0.038 0.047 0.054 0.061 0.067 0.073 0.078 0.083 0.088 0.109 0.128 0.145 0.162 0.194 0.225
0.16 0.041 0.050 0.058 0.065 0.072 0.078 0.083 0.088 0.093 0.116 0.136 0.155 0.173 0.207 0.240
0.17 0.043 0.053 0.062 0.069 0.076 0.082 0.088 0.094 0.099 0.124 0.145 0.165 0.184 0.220 0.255
0.18 0.046 0.056 0.065 0.073 0.080 0.087 0.093 0.099 0.105 0.131 0.154 0.175 0.194 0.233 0.270
0.19 0.049 0.060 0.069 0.077 0.085 0.092 0.099 0.105 0.111 0.138 0.162 0.184 0.205 0.246 0.285
0.20 0.051 0.063 0.073 0.081 0.089 0.097 0.104 0.110 0.117 0.145 0.171 0.194 0.216 0.259 0.300
Note. If the results of Ls/L or H/L are not on the chart exactly as calculated, go UP to the next higher value on the chart. For
example, if H/L = 0.021, use 0.03; if Ls/L = 0.0142, use 0.016. Intersect the Ls/L and H/L values on the chart to get the value
of LC/L. Multiply the LC/L value by L to get LC.
Table H-3. Minimum LC Values For Arch and Pinned-Footing Bridge Attacks
H/L 0.040 0.060 0.080 0.100 0.120 0.140 0.160 0.180 0.200
LC/L 0.003 0.007 0.013 0.020 0.030 0.040 0.053 0.067 0.083
H/L 0.220 0.240 0.260 0.280 0.300 0.320 0.340 0.360 —
LC/L 0.100 0.130 0.150 0.170 0.200 0.230 0.270 0.300 —
where—
H = rise for arch or portal bridges (measure the rise) [in meters] from the springing or bottom of the support
leg to the deck or top of the arch, whichever is greater)
L = length of span for attack between the centerlines of the bearings (in meters)
LC = required length of the span removed (in meters)
Note. If the result of H/L is not on the chart exactly as calculated, go UP to the next higher value on the chart. For example,
if H/L = 0.089, use 0.100 to determine LC/L. In this case, LC/L = 0.02. Multiply the LC/L value by L to get LC. For example,
0.02 x L = LC.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Top attack:
Through
Steel
1 bridge, None
beam
Method I
1. Cut at the midspan.
2. Cut the beams, including the bottom flange in a
“V.”
3. Do not consider cutting the deck.
Bottom attack: E is greater than ER
Through
Steel
2 bridge, None
beam
Method II
1. Cut at the midspan to 0.75H, as shown.
2. Cut the deck across the full bridge width.
Angled attack:
Top attack:
Through
Steel
5 bridge, None
beam
Method V
1. Cut at the midspan.
2. Cut the bridge as shown where the deck is located
well above the beam bottom.
3. Do not consider cutting the deck.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Angled attack: 1.
Configuration
found in
cantilever and
Deck
Steel suspended-
6 bridge, top
beam span bridges.
support 1. Cut between the 1/3 span and the midspan. 2. End
2. Cut the deck across the full bridge width. clearance is
not a
consideration.
Bottom attack: E is greater than ER
Deck
bridge,
Steel
7 bottom None
beam
support,
Method I 1. Cut at the midspan.
2. Do not consider cutting the deck.
Angled attack:
Deck
bridge, End clearance
Steel
9 bottom is not a
beam
support, consideration.
Method III
1. Cut between the 1/3 span and the midspan.
2. Cut the deck across the full bridge width.
Top attack:
Through
Steel
10 bridge, None
truss
Method I 1. Cut at the midspan.
2. Cut the top chord twice, vertically (if necessary),
diagonals, and bottom chord.
3. Remove the wind bracing over the midspan.
4. Do not consider cutting the deck.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Angled attack:
Through
Steel
11 bridge, None
truss
Method II 1. Cut between the 1/3 span and the midspan.
2. Cut the top chord, diagonals, and bottom chord in
one bay only.
3. Cut the deck across the full bridge width.
Bottom attack: 1.
Configuration
found in
cantilever and
Deck
Steel 1. Cut between the 1/3 span and the midspan. suspended-
12 bridge, top
truss 2. Cut the top chord, diagonals, and bottom chord in span bridges.
support
one bay only. 2. End
3. Do not consider cutting the deck. clearance is
not a
consideration.
Bottom attack: E is greater than ER
Deck
bridge,
Steel
13 bottom None
truss
support, 1. Cut at the midspan.
Method I 2. Cut the top chord, diagonals, and bottom chord in
one bay only.
3. Do not consider cutting the deck.
Angled attack:
Deck
bridge, End clearance
Steel
15 bottom is not a
truss
support, consideration.
Method III 1. Cut between the 1/3 span and midspan.
2. Cut the deck across the full bridge width.
Bottom attack:
This method
Through
16 Concrete applies to slab
bridge
bridges only.
1. Cut at the midspan.
2. Cut the deck across the full bridge width.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
1.
Configuration
Top attack: found in
cantilever and
suspended-
Deck
span bridges.
17 Concrete bridge, top
2. Remove
support Cut at the midspan with a concrete-stripping charge.
concrete for LC
distance to the
full width and
depth of
beams.
Bottom attack: E is greater than ER 1. This method
applies to slab
Deck
bridges only.
bridge,
2. Sufficient
18 Concrete bottom
reinforcing bars
support,
are cut to
Method I Cut at the midspan with hayricks.* cause bridge
collapse.
Deck
Bottom attack: E is less than ER
bridge, This method
1. Cut at the midspan with hayricks.*
19 Concrete bottom applies to slab
2. Attack one abutment or pier to create a sufficient
support, bridges only.
end clearance.
Method II
Top attack: E is less than ER
Remove
Deck
concrete for LC
bridge,
distance to full
20 Concrete bottom
width and
support,
depth of
Method III
Cut at the midspan with a concrete-stripping charge. beams.
Top attack:
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Top attack, plus girders:
Reinforced
22 Bowstring beam or None
truss
1. Cut the truss or beam with the appropriate method
(Serials 1 through 15).
2. Cut the bow in two places, including the hangers.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
1. Cutting
Two cuts: the anchor
span may
require a
two-stage
attack.
1 Concrete Cantilever
2. Use a
1. Cut the anchor span as closely to the pier as practical. concrete-
2. Cut the midspan shear joint. stripping
charge for
the first
stage.
1. Cutting
the anchor
span may
require a
two-stage
attack.
One cut: 2. Use a
concrete-
stripping
charge for
the first
Cantilever stage.
and 3. If
2 Concrete
suspended demolition of
span the
suspended
span will
create the
Cut the anchor as closely to the pier as practical. desired
obstacle,
regard the
span as
simply
supported
and attack
accordingly.
1. Cutting
longer
One cut: spans may
require a
Beam or two-stage
truss with attack.
3 Concrete
short side 2. Use a
span concrete-
stripping
1. Cut interior span so y is greater than 1.25x.
charge for
2. If necessary, cut other interior spans as in Serial 4.
the first
stage.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
1. Cutting
Two or more cuts: these spans
may require
a two-stage
Beam or
attack.
truss without
4 Concrete 2. Use a
short side
concrete-
span
stripping
Cut the interior span so y is greater than 1.25x. charge for
the first
stage.
Two cuts: 1. Cutting
these spans
may require
a two-stage
attack.
Portal, fixed
5 Concrete 2. Use a
footing
concrete-
stripping
charge for
Cut the span twice, close to the pier. the first
stage.
Strip concrete:
1. Remove
all concrete
for Lc.
2. A one-
stage attack
should be
adequate.
Portal,
3. When
6 Concrete pinned
footing
footing
conditions
are
unknown,
use Serial 5.
4. For Lc use
Table H-3,
Remove concrete from the midspan over length LC with a page H-3.
concrete-stripping charge.
Strip concrete:
1. Applies to
arches
greater than
35 meters.
Arch, open
2. A one-
spandrel,
7 Concrete stage attack
fixed footing,
should be
Method I
adequate.
3. For LC
Remove the concrete from the midspan over the length use
of Lc with a concrete-stripping charge. Table H-3.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Strip concrete:
1. Applies to
arches less
than
35 meters.
Arch, open 2. A one-
spandrel, stage attack
8 Concrete
fixed footing, should be
Method II adequate.
3. For LC
use
1. Remove the concrete from the midspan over the length
Table H-3,
of LC with a concrete-stripping charge.
page H-3.
2. Attack springing with hayricks* at the top face of the
arch ring.
1. This is an
alternative
to Method II,
Four cuts: applies to
arches less
than
35 meters.
2. Two-
Arch, open stage attack
spandrel, will probably
9 Concrete
fixed footing, be required.
Method III 3. Use a
concrete-
stripping
charge for
the first
stage.
4. For LC
use
Table H-3.
Strip concrete:
1. A one-
stage attack
Arch, open
should be
spandrel,
10 Concrete adequate.
pinned
2. For LC
footing
use
Table H-3.
Remove concrete from the midspan over the length of
LC with a concrete-stripping charge.
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Strip concrete: 1. This
applies to
arches of
span greater
than
35 meters
Arch, solid
only.
spandrel,
11 Concrete 2. A one-
fixed footing,
stage attack
Method I
should be
Remove the concrete from the midspan over the length adequate.
of LC with a concrete-stripping charge. 3. For LC
use
Table H-3,
page H-3.
Strip concrete:
1. Applies to
arches less
than
35 meters.
Arch, solid
2. A one-
spandrel,
12 Concrete stage attack
fixed footing,
should be
Method II 1. Remove concrete from the midspan over the length
adequate.
of LC with a concrete-stripping charge.
3. For LC
2. Attack both springing points with concrete-stripping
use
charges.
Table H-3.
コ Against the bottom face of the arch ring.
コ Against the top face (must remove the fill beneath
the roadway to access the arch ring).
Strip concrete:
1. A one-
stage attack
Arch, solid
should be
spandrel,
13 Concrete adequate.
pinned
2. For LC
footing
use
Remove concrete from the midspan over the length of Table H-3.
LC with a concrete-stripping charge.
Two cuts:
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
If demolition
One cut: of the
suspended
span will
create the
Cantilever
desired
and
15 Steel obstacle,
suspended
regard the
span
span as
simply
Cut anchor span as closely to the pier as practical. supported,
and attack
accordingly.
One cut:
Beam or
truss with
16 Steel None
short side
span
1. Cut the interior span so y is greater than 1.25x.
2. If necessary, cut other interior spans as in Serial 17.
Two or more cuts:
Beam or
truss without
17 Steel None
short side
span
Portal, fixed
18 Steel None
footing
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
Two cuts:
Two cuts:
Arch, open
spandrel, For LC, use
21 Steel
pinned Table H-3.
footing
Arch,
22 Masonry None
Method I
Sub-
Serial Type Attack Method Remarks
category
a b c d e
1. Use this
One cut: method as
an alternate
to Method I
only when
time is
Arch, insufficient
23 Masonry
Method II to allow
attack at the
haunches.
Breach the arch ring at the crown. 2. For LC,
use
Table H-3,
page H-3.
*Hayricks are not in the U.S. Army supply system.
Materials Sources
1 Adapter, priming 1375-00-565-4141
2 Bag, carrying M85 NSN/local purchase
3 Bag, plastic, 12 by 12 in 8105-00-837-7757
4 Box, cardboard, 7 by 1 3/4 by 1 3/4 in Local purchase
5 Box, cardboard, 11 3/4 by 2 1/4 by 2 1/4 in Local purchase
6 Box, wooden, bangalore torpedo TSC/DRMO
7 Box, wooden, cratering charge TSC/DRMO
8 Box, wooden, dynamite TSC/DRMO
9 Box, wooden, M112 TSC/DRMO
10 Box, wooden, M118 (sheet explosive) TSC/DRMO
11 Box, wooden, M183 TSC/DRMO
12 Box, wooden, M3 TSC/DRMO
13 Box, wooden, M2A3 TSC/DRMO
14 Box, wooden, M5A1 TSC/DRMO
15 Box, wooden, TNT TSC/DRMO
16 Cap, blasting, electric 1375-00-756-1865
17 Cap, blasting, nonelectric 1375-00-756-1864
18 Cap, plastic end, 1 1/4 in Local purchase
19 Cap, plastic end, 2 1/8 in Local purchase
20 Cap, plastic end, 7 in Local purchase
21 Chalk, field marking Local purchase
22 Charge, shaped, metal, M2A3 Local fabrication
23 Charge, shaped, metal, M3 Local fabrication
24 Clay, pottery, moist Local purchase
25 Cord, detonating 1375-00-965-0800
26 Coupling, plastic, 3/4 in 4730-00-472-5056
27 Coupling, plastic, 1 in 4730-00-472-5058
28 Fuse, time 1375-00-628-9033
29 Glue, super 8040-00-142-9193
30 Holder, blasting cap, M8 1375-00-926-4105
31 Label, bangalore torpedo DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
32 Label, cratering charges DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
33 Label, dynamite DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
34 Label, M112 DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
35 Label, M118 DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in (sheet TSC
explosive)
36 Label, M183 DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
Materials Sources
37 Label, M5A1 DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
38 Label, TNT DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
39 Label, shaped charge, 15 lb, DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
40 Label, shaped charge, 40 lb, DES, 3/8 in and 1 1/4 in TSC
41 M2 crimpers 5120-00-029-0683
42 Matting, floor, 1/8 in 7220-01-025-1695
43 Oil, mineral Local purchase
44 Sand Local purchase
45 Sandbag Local purchase
46 String NSN
47 Tape, clear 7510-00-995-0455
48 Tape, duct, green 7510-00-074-5124
49 Tape, electrical, black 5970-00-419-4291
50 Tape, fabric, olive drab green 7510-00-266-5016
51 Tape, fabric, red 7510-00-074-4969
52 Tape, PSA 7510-01-057-0096
53 Tube, cardboard, 10 by 2 1/8 in Local purchase
54 Tube, cardboard, 12 by 2 1/8 in Local purchase
55 Tube, cardboard, 24 by 7 in Local purchase
For an individual Soldier or item, this occurs often in the Soldier’s career or
A Frequent equipment service life.
For all Soldiers exposed or item inventory, this is continuously experienced.
For an individual Soldier or item, this occurs several times in the Soldier’s
B Likely career or equipment service life.
For all Soldiers exposed or item inventory, this occurs frequently.
For an individual Soldier or item, this occurs sometime in the Soldier’s career
or equipment service life.
C Occasional
For all Soldiers exposed or item inventory, this occurs sporadically or several
times in inventory service life.
For an individual Soldier or item, one can assume it will occur in the Soldier’s
career or equipment service life.
E Unlikely
For all Soldiers exposed or item inventory, it is possible but improbable;
occurs only very rarely.
Probability
Severity A B C D E
1 E E H H M
2 E H H M L
3 H M M L L
4 M L L L L
in inch(es)
int intelligence
IV intravenous
JP joint publication
kg kilogram(s)
kw kilowatt(s)
lin linear
lb pound(s)
m meter(s)
MANSCEN Maneuver Support Center
max maximum
MCO Marine Corps order
MCRP Marine Corps reference publication
MDI modernized demolition initiator
MGB medium girder bridge
MICLIC mine-clearing line charge
mil military
min minute(s)
mm millimeter(s)
mod modification
MSD minimum safe distance
NA not applicable
NATO North Atlantic Treaty Organization
NAVSEA Navy Sea Systems Command
NCO noncommissioned officer
NCOIC noncommissioned officer in charge
NEW net-explosive weight
No. number
NSN national stock number
OIC officer in charge
OPNAVINST Chief of Naval Operations instruction
oz ounce(s)
PE practice exercise
PETN pentaerythrite tetranitrate
PIR passive infrared
pkg package
POL petroleum, oils, and lubricants
PSA pressure sensitive adhesive
QD quality distance
QSTAG Quadripartite Standardization Agreement
qty quantity
SECTION II – TERMS
blast effect
(joint) Destruction of or damage to structures and personnel by the force of an explosion on or above
the surface of the ground. Blast effect may be contrasted with the cratering and ground-shock effects of
a projectile or charge that goes off beneath the surface. (JP 1-02) (FM 1-02)
demolition
(NATO) The destruction of structures, facilities, or material by use of fire, water, explosives,
mechanical, or other means. (FM 1-02)
demolition chamber
(joint, NATO) Space intentionally provided in a structure for the emplacement of explosive charges.
(JP 1-02)
demolition firing party
(joint) The party at the site that is technically responsible for the demolition and that actually initiates
detonation or fires the demolitions. See also demolition guard. (JP 1-02) (FM 1-02)
demolition guard
(joint, NATO) A local force positioned to ensure that a target is not captured by an enemy before
orders are given for its demolition and before the demolition has been successfully fired. The
commander of the demolition guard is responsible for the tactical control of all troops at the demolition
site, including the demolition firing party. The commander of the demolition guard is responsible for
transmitting the order to fire to the demolition firing party. (FM 1-02) (JP 1-02)
demolition kit
(joint, NATO) The demolition tool kit complete with explosives. (JP 1-02)
*demolition obstacle
An obstacle created by using explosives.
*demolition plan
Documentation with data required for the preparation of a single demolition.
demolition target
(joint, NATO) A target of known military interest identified for possible future demolition. (JP 1-02)
detonating cord
(joint, NATO) A waterproof, flexible fabric tube containing a high explosive designed to transmit the
detonation wave. (JP 1-02)
detonator
(joint, NATO) A device containing a sensitive explosive intended to produce a detonation wave.
(JP 1-02)
dual-firing circuit
(joint, NATO) An assembly comprising two independent firing systems, both electric or both non
electric, so that the firing of either system will detonate all charges. (JP 1-02)
dud
(joint, NATO) Explosive munition which has not been armed as intended or which has failed to
explode after being armed. (JP 1-02)
explosive ordnance disposal
(joint, NATO) The detection, identification, on-site evaluation, rendering safe, recovery, and final
disposal of unexploded explosive ordnance. It may also include explosive ordnance which has become
hazardous by damage or deterioration. Also called EOD. (JP 1-02)
fire
(joint, NATO) 1. The command given to discharge a weapon(s). 2. To detonate the main explosive
charge by means of a firing system. (JP 1-02) (FM 1-02)
firing circuit
(joint, NATO) 1. In land operations, an electrical circuit and/or pyrotechnic loop designed to detonate
connected charges from a firing point. 2. In naval mine warfare, that part of a mine circuit which either
completes the detonator circuit or operates a ship counter. (JP 1-02)
fuze
(NATO) A device which initiates an explosive train. (FM 1-02)
main detonating line
(joint, NATO) In demolition, a line of detonating cord used to transmit the detonation wave to two or
more branches. (JP 1-02)
pyrotechnic
(joint) A mixture of chemicals which, when ignited, is capable of reacting exothermically to produce
light, heat, smoke, sound, or gas. [Note: the Army definition adds, “…and may also be used to
introduce a delay into an explosive train because of its known burning time. The term excludes
propellants and explosives.”]. (FM 1-02) (JP 1-02)
shaped charge
(joint, NATO) A charge shaped so as to concentrate its explosive force in a particular direction.
(JP 1-02)
sympathetic detonation
(joint, NATO) Detonation of a charge by exploding another charge adjacent to it. (JP 1-02)
ARMY PUBLICATIONS
AR 75-14, Interservice Responsibilities for Explosive Ordnance Disposal (OPNAVINST 3027.1G;
AFR 136-8; MCO 8027.1D), 14 February 1992
AR 385-63, Range Safety {MCO 3570.1B}, 19 May 2003
AR 385-64, U.S. Army Explosives Safety Program, 1 February 2000
DA Pamphlet 385-63, Range Safety, 10 April 2003
DA Pamphlet 385-64, Ammunition and Explosives Safety Standards, 15 December 1999
FM 1-02, Operational Terms and Graphics {MCRP 5-12A}, 21 September 2004
FM 3-34.210, Explosive Hazards Operations, 27 March 2007
FM 3-34.465, Quarry Operations, 15 April 2005
FM 4-30.1, Munitions Distribution in the Theater of Operations, 16 December 2003
FM 4-30.51, Unexploded Ordnance (UXO) Procedures {MCRP 3-17.2A}, 13 July 2006
FM 5-19, Composite Risk Management, 21 August 2006
FM 5-34, Engineer Field Data {MCRP 3-17A}, 19 July 2005
TM 9-1300-214, Military Explosives, 20 September 1984
TM 9-1375-213-12, Operator’s and Unit Maintenance Manual (Including Repair Parts and Special
Tools List): Demolition Materials, 30 March 1973
TM 9-1375-213-34&P, Direct Support and General Support Maintenance Manual (Including Repair
Parts and Special Tool Lists) for Demolition Materials, 29 February 1996
TM 43-0001-38, Army Ammunition Data Sheets for Demolition Materials, 25 July 1994
JOINT PUBLICATIONS
JP 1-02. Department of Defense Dictionary of Military and Associated Terms, 12 April 2001
MISCELLANEOUS
Volume 23, Chapter I, Part 266, Subpart M, Title 40, CFR, Protection of Environment, 1 July 2002
DoD Consolidated Ammunition Supply Catalog
Military Munitions Rule: Hazardous Waste Identification and Management; Explosives Emergencies;
Manifest Exemption for Transport of Hazardous Waste on Right-of-Way on Contiguous
Properties, 12 August 1997
NAVSEA SW060-AA-MMA-010, Demolition Materials, 1 October 1995
NAVSEA SW061-AA-MMA-010, Use of Explosives in Underwater Salvage,1 January 1994
Public Law 94-580, Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, 21 October 1976
Federal Compliance Act, Section 107, Munitions, 1992
United Nations Convention on Certain Conventional Weapons, 2 December 1983
STANDARDIZATION AGREEMENTS
STANAG 2017 (ENGR), Edition 4. Orders to the Demolition Guard Commander and Demolition
Firing Party Commander (Non-Nuclear), 28 January 1999
STANAG 2077 (INT), Edition 5. Orders of Battle, 1 February 1995
STANAG 2123 (ENGR), Edition 2. Obstacle Folder, 30 November 1984
DOCUMENTS NEEDED
These documents must be available to the intended users of this publication.
DA Form 2028, Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms
*DA Form 2203, Demolition Reconnaissance Record
*This source was also used to develop this publication.
READINGS RECOMMENDED
These sources contain relevant supplemental information.
None.
metric charge calculations, B-1 bangalore torpedo DES, SLAM. See selectable
metric conversion chart, A-1 5-41 lightweight attack munition
M183 demolition satchel (SLAM), 1-13
military explosives destruction, charge DES, 5-36
6-14 solid waste, 6-16
M2A3 15-pound, shaped
minimum ER values for bottom charge DES, 5-37 spalling, 3-1, 3-17, 3-21
attack, H-1 M3 40-pound shaped special instructions, 5-6
minimum Lc values charge DES, 5-38 splice, Western Union pigtail,
for arch and pinned-footing M5A1 demolition block 2-11
bridge attack, H-3 DES, 5-35
standoff formula for
for top attack (midspan), DES without internal
overpressure, 7-6
H-2 detonating cord boosters
1-pound TNT-block DES, states of readiness
minimum safe distance (MSD), state 1 (safe), 5-3
5-29
2-45, 7-4 state 2 (armed), 5-3
M1 military dynamite
minishock tube DES, 5-31 static electricity, 6-6
five hundred-foot, 2-38 M112 (composition C4)
one thousand-foot, 2-43 steel bars, rods, chains, and
block DES cables
misfire, 2-76 MDI, 5-29 over 2 inches, 3-13
prevention, 3-27 M112 (Composition C4) up to 2 inches, 3-12
procedures, 6-9 block DES, 5-28
sheet explosive DES, 5 stemming, 3-2
missile hazards, 6-7
26 storage
modernized demolition initiator MDI, 5-27 temporary, 6-14
(MDI), 1-18
storage safety
MSD. See minimum safe Q
magazines, 6-13
distance (MSD), 2-45 quarrying, 3-33 permanent, 6-13
N temporary, 6-14
R
net-explosive weight (NEW), survivability positions, 3-33
railroad rails, 3-13
7-3 rapid wall-breaching kit T
NEW. See net explosive weight (RWBK), 7-31 tamping, 3-2
(NEW), 7-3 RE factor, 3-4 tamping factor, B-4
nonelectric blasting cap reconnaissance
M11, 2-34 taproot, 3-30
orders, 5-5
M12, 2-36 time fuse, 6-3, 6-8
record, 5-6
M13, 2-40 TNT. See trinitrotoluene (TNT),
M14, 2-44 reload kit, 1-17
1-3
M15, 2-48 reserved demolitions
TNT-block, 5-10
M18, 2-46 command and control, 5-4
M19, 2-54 toxicity, 6-5
risk-assessment checklist, K-1
M21, 2-38 transportation
RWBK. See rapid wall-
M23, 2-43 cargo (explosives), 6-13
breaching kit (RWBK), 7-31
nonelectric firing devices fire, 6-13
M60 fuse igniter, 1-30 S regulations, 6-12
M81 fuse igniter, 1-31 safety procedures, 6-12
safe distances, 6-8
vehicles, 6-12
nonelectric initiating sets, 2-1 sandbar removal, G-7
trenching and tunneling, G-4
O scanman knot, D-8
trinitrotoluene (TNT), 1-3
obstacle folder, 5-6 selectable, lightweight attack
munition (SLAM), 1-13 U
ohm’s law, E-1
series circuit calculations, E-2 underwater operations, 6-7
P ship salvage, G-1 detonating cord, 6-8
picric acid, 1-4 explosives, 6-7
shock tube, 2-31 M60 Fuse Igniters, 6-8
priming methods, 2-11, 5-25 five hundred-foot, 2-36 MDI components, 6-8
DES with internal one thousand-foot, 2-40 nonelectric caps, 6-7
detonating cord boosters, thirty-foot, 2-34 time fuse, 6-8
5-34 shock tube splicing, 2-74
40-pound cratering V
charge DES, 5-40
voltage drop, E-3
Official:
JOYCE E. MORROW
Administrative Assistant to the
Secretary of the Army
0717101
DISTRIBUTION:
Active Army, Army National Guard, and U.S. Army Reserve: To be distributed in accordance with the
initial distribution number (IDN) 110022, requirements for FM 3-34.214.
PIN 084115-000